blob: 520db412679e38aa91e043d22a556d82132b21e1 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau86512dd2021-04-09 17:10:39 +02007 2021/04/09
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
749See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100751
7522.4. Conditional blocks
753-----------------------
754
755It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
756some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
757ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
758configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
759versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
760preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
761text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
762lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
763switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
764are defined to form conditional blocks:
765
766 - .if <condition>
767 - .elif <condition>
768 - .else
769 - .endif
770
771The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
772as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
773matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
774there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
775only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
776".elif" of a block.
777
778Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
779ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
780as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
781
782The conditions are currently limited to:
783
784 - an empty string, always returns "false"
785 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
786 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
787
788Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
789functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
790
791Three other directives are provided to report some status:
792
793 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
794 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
795 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
796
797Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
798"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
799fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
800provide advice to the user.
801
802Example:
803
804 .if "${A}"
805 .if "${B}"
806 .notice "A=1, B=1"
807 .elif "${C}"
808 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
809 .elif "${D}"
810 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
811 .else
812 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
813 .endif
814 .else
815 .notice "A=0"
816 .endif
817
818
8192.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200820----------------
821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100822Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100823values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
824otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
825numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
826for every keyword. Supported units are :
827
828 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
829 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
830 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
831 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
832 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
833 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
834
835
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008362.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200837-------------
838
839 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
840 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
841 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
842 global
843 daemon
844 maxconn 256
845
846 defaults
847 mode http
848 timeout connect 5000ms
849 timeout client 50000ms
850 timeout server 50000ms
851
852 frontend http-in
853 bind *:80
854 default_backend servers
855
856 backend servers
857 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
858
859
860 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
861 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
862 global
863 daemon
864 maxconn 256
865
866 defaults
867 mode http
868 timeout connect 5000ms
869 timeout client 50000ms
870 timeout server 50000ms
871
872 listen http-in
873 bind *:80
874 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
875
876
877Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
878
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100879 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200880
881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008823. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883--------------------
884
885Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
886are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
887of them have command-line equivalents.
888
889The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
890
891 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200892 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200894 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200895 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200897 - description
898 - deviceatlas-json-file
899 - deviceatlas-log-level
900 - deviceatlas-separator
901 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900902 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200903 - gid
904 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100905 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200906 - h1-case-adjust
907 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100908 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100909 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100910 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200911 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200913 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100914 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200915 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100916 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100917 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200918 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200920 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200921 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200923 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100924 - presetenv
925 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200926 - uid
927 - ulimit-n
928 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200929 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100930 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100931 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200932 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200933 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200934 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200935 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200936 - ssl-default-bind-options
937 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200938 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200939 - ssl-default-server-options
940 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100941 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200942 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100943 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100944 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100945 - 51degrees-data-file
946 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200947 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200948 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200949 - wurfl-data-file
950 - wurfl-information-list
951 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200952 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100953 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100954
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100956 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200957 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200959 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100960 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100961 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100962 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200963 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200964 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200965 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200966 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200967 - noepoll
968 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000969 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100971 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300972 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000973 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100974 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200975 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200976 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200977 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000978 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000979 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200980 - tune.buffers.limit
981 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200982 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200983 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100984 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200985 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200986 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200987 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200988 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100989 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200990 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200991 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200992 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100993 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100994 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100995 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100996 - tune.lua.session-timeout
997 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200998 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100999 - tune.maxaccept
1000 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001001 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001002 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001003 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001004 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1005 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001006 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1007 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001008 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001009 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001010 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001011 - tune.sndbuf.client
1012 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001013 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001014 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001015 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001016 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001017 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001018 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001019 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001020 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001021 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001022 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001023 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1024 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1025 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001026 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1027 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001028
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001029 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001031 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
1033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010343.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035------------------------------------
1036
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001037ca-base <dir>
1038 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001039 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1040 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1041 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001042
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043chroot <jail dir>
1044 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1045 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1046 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1047 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1048 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001049 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001050
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001051cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1052 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1053 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1054 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1055 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1056 set. These sets have the format
1057
1058 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1059
1060 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001061 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001062 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1063 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001064 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1065 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001066 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001067 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001068 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001069 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001070 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
1071 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
1072 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
1073 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001074
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001075 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1076 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1077 on the machine's word size.
1078
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001079 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001080 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1081 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1082 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1083 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1084 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1085 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001086
1087 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001088 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1089
1090 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1091 # first 4 CPUs
1092
1093 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1094 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1095 # word size.
1096
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001097 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001098 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001099 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1100 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1101 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1102
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001103 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1104 # and so on.
1105 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1106 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1107 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1108
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001109 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001110 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1111 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1112 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1113
1114 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1115 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1116 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1117
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001118 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1119 # and a thread range.
1120 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1121 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1122 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1123
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001124crt-base <dir>
1125 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001126 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1127 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001128
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001129daemon
1130 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1131 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001132 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1133 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001134
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001135deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1136 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001137 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001138
1139deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001140 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001141 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1142
1143deviceatlas-separator <char>
1144 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1145 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1146
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001147deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001148 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1149 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1150 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001151
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001152external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001153 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1154 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001155 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1156 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1157 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1158 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1159 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001160
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001161gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001162 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001163 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1164 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001165 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1166 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001167 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001168
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001169group <group name>
1170 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1171 See also "gid" and "user".
1172
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001173hard-stop-after <time>
1174 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1175
1176 Arguments :
1177 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1178 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1179 SIGUSR1 signal.
1180
1181 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1182 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1183 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1184
1185 Example:
1186 global
1187 hard-stop-after 30s
1188
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001189h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1190 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1191 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1192 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1193 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001194 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001195 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1196 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1197 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1198 specified in a proxy.
1199
1200 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1201 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1202 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1203 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1204 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1205 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1206 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1207
1208 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1209 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1210 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1211 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1212 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1213
1214 Example:
1215 global
1216 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1217
1218 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1219 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1220
1221h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1222 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1223 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1224 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1225 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1226 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1227 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1228 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1229 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1230
1231 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1232 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1233 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1234
1235 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1236 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1237
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001238insecure-fork-wanted
1239 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1240 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1241 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1242 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1243 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1244 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1245 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1246 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1247 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1248 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1249 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1250 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1251 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1252 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1253 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1254 disable it.
1255
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001256insecure-setuid-wanted
1257 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1258 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1259 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1260 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1261 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1262 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1263 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1264 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1265 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1266 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1267 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1268 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1269 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1270 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1271
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001272issuers-chain-path <dir>
1273 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1274 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1275 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1276 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1277 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1278 "issuers-chain-path".
1279 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1280 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1281 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1282 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1283 will share the chain in memory.
1284
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001285localpeer <name>
1286 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1287 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1288 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1289 the configuration parsing.
1290
1291 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1292 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1293
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001294log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001295 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001296 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001297 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001298 configured with "log global".
1299
1300 <address> can be one of:
1301
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001302 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001303 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1304 port).
1305
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001306 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1307 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1308 port).
1309
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001310 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001311 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1312 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001313 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001314
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001315 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1316 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1317 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1318 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1319 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1320 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1321 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1322 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1323 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1324 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1325 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1326 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1327 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1328 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001329 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1330 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001331
1332 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1333 "fd@2", see above.
1334
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001335 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1336 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1337 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1338 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1339 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1340
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001341 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1342 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001343
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001344 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1345 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1346 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1347 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1348 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1349 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1350 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1351 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1352 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1353 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001354 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1355 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001356
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001357 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1358 one of the following :
1359
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001360 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1361 field is stripped. This is the default.
1362 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1363 rfc3164.
1364
1365 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001366 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1367
1368 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1369 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1370
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001371 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1372 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1373 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1374 designed to be used with a local log server.
1375
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001376 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1377 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1378 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1379 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1380 logger consumes.
1381
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001382 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1383 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1384 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1385 used with a local log server.
1386
1387 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1388 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1389 designed to be used with a local log server.
1390
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001391 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1392 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1393 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1394 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1395
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001396 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1397 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1398 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1399 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1400 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1401
1402 <sample_size>
1403 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1404 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1405 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1406 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1407 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1408
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001409 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001410
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001411 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1412 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1413 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1414
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001415 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1416 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1417 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1418 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
1420 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001421 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1422 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1423 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1424 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1425 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1426 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001428 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001429
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001430log-send-hostname [<string>]
1431 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1432 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1433 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1434 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1435 the logs.
1436
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001437log-tag <string>
1438 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1439 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1440 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001441 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001442
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001443lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001444 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1445 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1446 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1447 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1448 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1449 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001450 used multiple times.
1451
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001452lua-load-per-thread <file>
1453 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1454 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1455 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1456 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1457 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1458 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1459 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1460 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1461 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1462 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1463 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1464 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1465 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1466 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1467 times.
1468
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001469lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1470 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1471 variable.
1472 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1473 to "path".
1474
1475 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1476 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1477 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1478 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1479 will be checked earlier.
1480
1481 As an example by specifying the following path:
1482
1483 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1484 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1485
1486 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1487 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1488 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1489 paths if that does not exist either.
1490
1491 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1492 documentation.
1493
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001494master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001495 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1496 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1497 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001498 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001499 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1500 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001501 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1502 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1503 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1504 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1505 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001506
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001507 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001508
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001509mworker-max-reloads <number>
1510 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001511 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001512 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1513 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1514 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1515
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001516nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001517 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1518 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1519 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001520 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1521 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001522 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1523 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1524 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001525
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001526nbthread <number>
1527 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001528 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1529 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1530 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1531 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1532 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001533 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1534 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1535 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1536 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1537 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1538 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1539 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001542 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1543 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1544 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1545 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001546
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001547pp2-never-send-local
1548 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1549 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1550 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1551 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1552 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1553 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1554 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1555 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1556 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1557 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1558 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1559
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001560presetenv <name> <value>
1561 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1562 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1563 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1564 and "unsetenv".
1565
1566resetenv [<name> ...]
1567 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1568 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1569 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1570 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1571 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1572 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1573 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1574 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1575
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001576stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001577 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1578 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1579 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1580 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1581 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1582 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001583 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001584 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1585 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1586 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1587 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001588
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001589server-state-base <directory>
1590 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001591 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1592 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001593
1594server-state-file <file>
1595 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1596 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1597 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1598 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1599 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1600 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1601 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1602 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001603 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1604 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001605
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001606set-var <var-name> <expr>
1607 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1608 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1609 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1610 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1611 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1612 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1613 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1614 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1615 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1616
1617 Example:
1618 global
1619 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1620 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1621 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1622
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001623setenv <name> <value>
1624 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1625 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1626 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1627 and "unsetenv".
1628
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001629set-dumpable
1630 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001631 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1632 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1633 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1634 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1635 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1636 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1637 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1638 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1639 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1640 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1641 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1642 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1643 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1644 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1645 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1646 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1647 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001648
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001649ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1650 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1651 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001652 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001653 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001654 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1655 information and recommendations see e.g.
1656 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1657 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1658 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1659 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001660
1661ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1662 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1663 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1664 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1665 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1666 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001667 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1668 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1669 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001670 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001671
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001672ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1674 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1675 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1676 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1677 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1678
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001679ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1681 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1682 keyword to see available options.
1683
1684 Example:
1685 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001686 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001687
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001688ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1690 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001691 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001692 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001693 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1694 information and recommendations see e.g.
1695 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1696 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1697 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1698 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1699 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001700
1701ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1702 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1703 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1704 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1705 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1706 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001707 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1708 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1709 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1710 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001711
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001712ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1714 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1715 keyword to see available options.
1716
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001717ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1718 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1719 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1720 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001721 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001722 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001723 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1724 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1725 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1726 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001727 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1728 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1729 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1730
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001731ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1732 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1733 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001734 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001735 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001736 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1737
1738 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001739
1740 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1741 and won't try to remove them.
1742
1743 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1744
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001745ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001746 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001747 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1748 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001749
1750 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1751 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1752 optimize the startup time.
1753
1754 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1755 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1756 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1757
1758 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001759 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001760
1761 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001762 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1763
1764 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1765 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1766 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1767 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1768 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1769 bind configuration..
1770
1771 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1772 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1773 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1774 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1775 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1776 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1777 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1778 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1779
1780 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1781
1782 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1783 a cert bundle.
1784
1785 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1786 separately in several "crt".
1787
1788 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1789 since files are loading separately.
1790
1791 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1792 required to commit them.
1793
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001794 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001795 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001796
1797 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1798
1799 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1800
1801 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1802 not provided in the PEM file.
1803
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001804 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1805 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1806
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001807 The default behavior is "all".
1808
1809 Example:
1810 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1811 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1812 ssl-load-extra-files none
1813
1814 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1815
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001816ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1817 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1818 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1819 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1820
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001821ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001822 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001823 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1824 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1825 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1826 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1827 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1828 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001829 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001830
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001831stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1832 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1833 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1834 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001835 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001836 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001837
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001838 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1839 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1840 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001841
1842stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1843 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1844 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001845 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001846
1847stats maxconn <connections>
1848 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1849 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001851uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001852 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001853 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1854 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1855 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1856
1857ulimit-n <number>
1858 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1859 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1860 option.
1861
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001862unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1863 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1864
1865 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1866 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1867 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1868 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1869 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1870 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1871 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1872 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1873 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1874 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1875
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001876unsetenv [<name> ...]
1877 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1878 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1879 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1880 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1881 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1882 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1883 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1884
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001885user <user name>
1886 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1887 See also "uid" and "group".
1888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001889node <name>
1890 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1891
1892 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1893 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1894 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1895 traffic.
1896
1897description <text>
1898 Add a text that describes the instance.
1899
1900 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1901 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1902 "<" and ">" characters.
1903
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100190451degrees-data-file <file path>
1905 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001906 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001907
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001908 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001909 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1910
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000191151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001912 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1913 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1914 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1915
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001916 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001917 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1918
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200191951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001920 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1921 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1922
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001923 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1924 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1925
192651degrees-cache-size <number>
1927 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1928 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1929 By default, this cache is disabled.
1930
1931 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001932 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1933
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001934wurfl-data-file <file path>
1935 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1936 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1937
1938 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1939 with USE_WURFL=1.
1940
1941wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1942 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1943 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1944 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1945
1946 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1947
1948 Valid WURFL properties are:
1949 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1950
1951 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1952 device.
1953
1954 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1955 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1956
1957 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1958 particular web request.
1959
1960 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1961 used Libwurfl API version.
1962
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001963 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1964 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1965
1966 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1967 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1968
1969 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1970
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001971 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1972 with USE_WURFL=1.
1973
1974wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1975 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1976 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1977
1978 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1979 with USE_WURFL=1.
1980
1981wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1982 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1983 thus before the chroot.
1984
1985 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1986 with USE_WURFL=1.
1987
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001988wurfl-cache-size <size>
1989 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1990 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001991 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001992 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001993
1994 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1995 with USE_WURFL=1.
1996
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001997strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001998 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1999 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2000 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2001 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2002 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020043.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005-----------------------
2006
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002007busy-polling
2008 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2009 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2010 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2011 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2012 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2013 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2014 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2015 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2016 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2017 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2018 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2019 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2020 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2021 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2022 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2023 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2024 "poll" pollers.
2025
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002026 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2027 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2028 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2029
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002030max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2031 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2032 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2033 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2034 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2035 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2036 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2037 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2038 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2039
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002040maxconn <number>
2041 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2042 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2043 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002044 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2045 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2046 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2047 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002048 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2049 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2050 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2051 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2052 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2053 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002054
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002055maxconnrate <number>
2056 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2057 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2058 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2059 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2060 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2061 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2062 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2063 fairness.
2064
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002065maxcomprate <number>
2066 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002067 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002068 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2069 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2070 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002071 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002072 default value.
2073
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002074maxcompcpuusage <number>
2075 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2076 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2077 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2078 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2079 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2080 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2081 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2082 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2083
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002084maxpipes <number>
2085 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2086 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2087 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2088 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2089 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2090 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2091
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002092maxsessrate <number>
2093 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2094 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2095 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2096 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2097 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2098 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2099 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2100 fairness.
2101
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002102maxsslconn <number>
2103 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2104 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2105 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2106 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2107 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2108 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2109 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002110 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2111 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2112 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2113 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2114 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2115 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2116 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002117
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002118maxsslrate <number>
2119 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2120 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2121 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2122 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2123 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2124 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2125 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2126 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2127 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2128 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2129
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002130maxzlibmem <number>
2131 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2132 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2133 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002134 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2135 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2136 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002138noepoll
2139 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2140 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002141 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002142
2143nokqueue
2144 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2145 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2146 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2147
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002148noevports
2149 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2150 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2151 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2152 also "nopoll".
2153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002154nopoll
2155 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2156 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002158 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2159 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002160
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002161nosplice
2162 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002163 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002164 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002165 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002166 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2167 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2168 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2169 "option splice-response".
2170
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002171nogetaddrinfo
2172 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2173 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2174
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002175noreuseport
2176 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2177 command line argument "-dR".
2178
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002179profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2180 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2181 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2182 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2183 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002184 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002185 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2186 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2187 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2188 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2189
2190 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2191 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2192 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2193 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2194 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002195 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2196 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2197 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2198 CLI.
2199
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002200spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002201 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2202 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2203 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2204 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2205 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2206 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002207
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002208ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002209 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002210 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002211 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2212 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2213 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2214 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2215 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002216 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2217 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002218 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2219 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2220 openssl configuration file uses:
2221 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2222
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002223ssl-mode-async
2224 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002225 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002226 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2227 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2228 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002229 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002230 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002231
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002232tune.buffers.limit <number>
2233 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2234 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2235 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2236 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2237 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002238 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002239 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2240 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2241 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2242 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2243 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2244 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2245 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2246 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2247 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2248
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002249tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2250 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2251 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2252 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2253 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2254
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002255tune.bufsize <number>
2256 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2257 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2258 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2259 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2260 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2261 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2262 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002263 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2264 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2265 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002266 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002267 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2268 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2269 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002270
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002271tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2272 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002273
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002274tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2275 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2276 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2277 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2278 this value. The default value is 1.
2279
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002280tune.fail-alloc
2281 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2282 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2283 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2284 gracefully.
2285
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002286tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2287 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2288 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2289 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2290 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2291 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2292
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002293tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2294 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2295 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2296 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2297 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2298 change it.
2299
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002300tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2301 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002302 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2303 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002304 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2305 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2306 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2307 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2308 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2309
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002310tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2311 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2312 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2313 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2314 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2315 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2316 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2317 recommended not to change this value.
2318
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002319tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2320 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2321 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2322 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2323 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2324 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2325 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2326 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2327
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002328tune.http.cookielen <number>
2329 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2330 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2331 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2332 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2333 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2334 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2335 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2336 to change this value.
2337
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002338tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002339 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2340 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002341 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002342 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002343 configuration directives too.
2344 The default value is 1024.
2345
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002346tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2347 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2348 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2349 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2350 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2351 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2352 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002353 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2354 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2355 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002356
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002357tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2358 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2359 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2360 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2361 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2362 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2363 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002364 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2365 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2366 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2367 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2368 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002369
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002370tune.idletimer <timeout>
2371 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2372 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2373 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2374 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2375 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2376 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002377 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002378 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002379 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2380
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002381tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2382 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2383 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2384 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2385 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2386 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2387 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2388 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2389 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2390 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2391
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002392tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2393 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002394 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002395 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2396 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002397 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002398 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2399 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2400
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002401tune.lua.maxmem
2402 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2403 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2404 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2405 memory.
2406
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002407tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2408 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002409 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2410 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002411 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002412
2413tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2414 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2415 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2416 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2417 check servers.
2418
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002419tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2420 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2421 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2422 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002423 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002424
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002425tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002426 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2427 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002428 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2429 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2430 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2431 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2432 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2433 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2434 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2435 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2436 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002437
2438tune.maxpollevents <number>
2439 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2440 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2441 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2442 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2443 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2444
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002445tune.maxrewrite <number>
2446 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2447 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2448 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2449 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2450 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2451 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2452 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2453 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2454 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2455 bufsize.
2456
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002457tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2458 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2459 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2460 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2461 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2462 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2463 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2464 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2465 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2466 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002467 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2468 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002469 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2470 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2471 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2472 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2473 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2474 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2475 setting this parameter to 0.
2476
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002477tune.pipesize <number>
2478 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2479 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2480 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2481 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2482 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2483 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2484
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002485tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2486 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2487 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2488 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2489 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2490 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2491 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002492 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002493
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002494tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2495 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2496 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2497 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2498 default is 20.
2499
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002500tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2501tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2502 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2503 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2504 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002505 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002506 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002507 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2508 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2509
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002510tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002511 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002512 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2513 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2514 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2515 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2516
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002517tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002518 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002519 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2520 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2521 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2522 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2523 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2524 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2525 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002526
2527tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2528 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2529 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2530 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2531 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2532 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2533 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2534 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2535 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2536 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002537
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002538tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2539tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2540 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2541 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2542 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002543 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002544 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002545 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2546 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2547 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2548 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2549 notifying haproxy again.
2550
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002551tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002552 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002553 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2554 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2555 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2556 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2557 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2558 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2559 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2560 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2561 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2562 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2563 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002564
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002565tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002566 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002567 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2568 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2569 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2570 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2571 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2572
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002573tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2574 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2575 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2576 performances. This is disabled by default.
2577
2578 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2579 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2580
2581 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2582
2583 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2584
2585 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2586
2587 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2588 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2589 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2590
2591 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2592 converted.
2593
2594 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2595 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2596 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2597 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2598 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2599 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2600 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002601 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2602 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002603
2604 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2605
2606 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2607 only need this line:
2608
2609 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2610
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002611tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2612 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002613 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002614 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2615 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2616 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2617 being used for too long.
2618
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002619tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2620 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2621 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2622 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2623 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2624 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2625 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2626 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2627 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2628 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2629 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002630 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002631 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002632
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002633tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2634 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2635 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2636 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2637 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002638 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002639 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2640 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002641 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2642 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002643
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002644tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2645 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2646 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2647 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2648 1000 entries.
2649
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002650tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2651 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2652 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2653 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2654
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002655tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002656tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002657tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2658tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2659tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002660 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2661 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2662 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2663 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2664 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2665 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2666 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2667 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002668
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002669 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2670 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2671 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2672 all available space is consumed.
2673 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2674 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2675 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002676
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002677tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2678 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002679 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002680 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002681 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002682 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2683
2684tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2685 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2686 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002687 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2688 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026903.3. Debugging
2691--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002692
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002693quiet
2694 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2695 line argument "-q".
2696
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002697zero-warning
2698 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2699 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2700 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2701 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2702 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2703 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2704
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010027063.4. Userlists
2707--------------
2708It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2709http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2710it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2711
2712userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002713 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002714 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2715
2716group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002717 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002718 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2719 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2720
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002721user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2722 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002723 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2724 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002725 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2726 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2727 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2728 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002729
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002730 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2731 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2732 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2733 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2734 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2735 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2736 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2737 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2738 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002739
2740 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002741 userlist L1
2742 group G1 users tiger,scott
2743 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002744
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002745 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2746 user scott insecure-password elgato
2747 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002748
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002749 userlist L2
2750 group G1
2751 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002752
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002753 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2754 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2755 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002756
2757 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002758
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002759
27603.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002761----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002762It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2763several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2764instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2765values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2766automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2767In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2768using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2769tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2770reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2771Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2772that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2773each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002774
2775peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002776 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002777 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2778
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002779bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2780 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2781 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2782
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002783disabled
2784 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2785 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2786 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2787
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002788default-bind [param*]
2789 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2790
2791default-server [param*]
2792 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2793
2794 Arguments:
2795 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2796 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2797 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2798 details.
2799
2800
2801 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2802
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002803enable
2804 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2805
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002806log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002807 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2808 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2809 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2810 more details.
2811
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002812peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002813 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2814 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002815 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2816 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2817 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2818 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2819 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002820
2821 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2822 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2823
2824 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002825 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2826 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2827 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002828
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002829 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2830 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002831
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002832 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2833 "server" keyword explanation below).
2834
2835server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002836 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002837 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2838 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2839 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2840 of this "peers" section).
2841 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2842
2843
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002844 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002845 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002846 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002847 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2848 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2849 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002850
2851 backend mybackend
2852 mode tcp
2853 balance roundrobin
2854 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2855 stick on src
2856
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002857 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2858 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002859
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002860 Example:
2861 peers mypeers
2862 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2863 default-server ssl verify none
2864 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2865 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002866
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002867
2868table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2869 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2870
2871 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2872 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002873 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002874 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2875 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2876 "stick-table" keyword).
2877
2878 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2879 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2880 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2881 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2882 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2883 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2884 of the stick-table name as follows:
2885
2886 peers mypeers
2887 peer A ...
2888 peer B ...
2889 table t1 ...
2890
2891 frontend fe1
2892 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2893
2894 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2895 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2896
2897 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2898 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2899 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2900 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2901 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2902 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2903 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2904
2905 peers mypeers
2906 peer A ...
2907 peer B ...
2908 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2909
2910 backend t1
2911 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2912
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002913 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002914 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2915 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2916
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090029173.6. Mailers
2918------------
2919It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2920If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2921in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2922
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002923mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002924 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2925 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2926
2927mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2928 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2929
2930 Example:
2931 mailers mymailers
2932 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2933 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2934
2935 backend mybackend
2936 mode tcp
2937 balance roundrobin
2938
2939 email-alert mailers mymailers
2940 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2941 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2942
2943 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2944 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2945
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002946timeout mail <time>
2947 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2948 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2949 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2950 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2951
2952 Example:
2953 mailers mymailers
2954 timeout mail 20s
2955 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002956
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020029573.7. Programs
2958-------------
2959In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2960master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2961managed the same way as the workers.
2962
2963During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2964sequence as a worker:
2965
2966 - the master is re-executed
2967 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2968 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2969 instance of the program
2970
2971During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2972
2973program <name>
2974 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2975 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2976 the management guide).
2977
2978command <command> [arguments*]
2979 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2980 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2981 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2982 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2983
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002984user <user name>
2985 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2986 See also "group".
2987
2988group <group name>
2989 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2990 See also "user".
2991
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002992option start-on-reload
2993no option start-on-reload
2994 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2995 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2996 program section.
2997
2998
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010029993.8. HTTP-errors
3000----------------
3001
3002It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3003imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3004several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3005
3006http-errors <name>
3007 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3008 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3009
3010errorfile <code> <file>
3011 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3012
3013 Arguments :
3014 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003015 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003016 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003017
3018 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3019 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3020 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3021 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3022 before any chroot is performed.
3023
3024 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3025
3026 Example:
3027 http-errors website-1
3028 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3029 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3030 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3031
3032 http-errors website-2
3033 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3034 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3035 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3036
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020030373.9. Rings
3038----------
3039
3040It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3041servers or traces.
3042
3043ring <ringname>
3044 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3045
3046description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003047 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003048 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3049
3050format <format>
3051 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3052
3053 Arguments:
3054 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3055 one of the following :
3056
3057 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3058 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3059 designed to be used with a local log server.
3060
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003061 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3062 field is stripped. This is the default.
3063 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3064 rfc3164.
3065
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003066 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3067 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3068 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3069 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3070 is the default.
3071
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003072 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003073 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3074
3075 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3076 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3077
3078 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3079 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3080 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3081 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3082 logger consumes.
3083
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003084 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3085 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3086 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3087 with a local log server.
3088
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003089 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3090 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3091 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3092 used with a local log server.
3093
3094maxlen <length>
3095 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3096 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3097 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3098
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003099server <name> <address> [param*]
3100 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3101 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3102 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3103 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3104 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3105 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3106 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3107 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3108 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003109 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3110 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003111
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003112size <size>
3113 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3114 set to BUFSIZE.
3115
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003116timeout connect <timeout>
3117 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3118
3119 Arguments :
3120 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3121 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3122 as explained at the top of this document.
3123
3124timeout server <timeout>
3125 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3126
3127 Arguments :
3128 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3129 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3130 as explained at the top of this document.
3131
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003132 Example:
3133 global
3134 log ring@myring local7
3135
3136 ring myring
3137 description "My local buffer"
3138 format rfc3164
3139 maxlen 1200
3140 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003141 timeout connect 5s
3142 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003143 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003144
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020031453.10. Log forwarding
3146-------------------
3147
3148It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3149haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3150
3151log-forward <name>
3152 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3153
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003154backlog <conns>
3155 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3156 on connections accept.
3157
3158bind <addr> [param*]
3159 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003160 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3161 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3162 syslog protocol over TCP.
3163 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003164 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3165
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003166dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003167 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3168 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3169 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3170 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003171 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003172
3173log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003174log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003175 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3176 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3177 documentation.
3178 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3179 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3180 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3181 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3182 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3183
3184 Example:
3185 global
3186 log stderr format iso local7
3187
3188 ring myring
3189 description "My local buffer"
3190 format rfc5424
3191 maxlen 1200
3192 size 32764
3193 timeout connect 5s
3194 timeout server 10s
3195 # syslog tcp server
3196 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3197
3198 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003199 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3200 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003201 # all messages on stderr
3202 log global
3203 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3204 log ring@myring local0
3205 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3206 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3207 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3208 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3209 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003210
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003211maxconn <conns>
3212 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3213 10 is the default.
3214
3215timeout client <timeout>
3216 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032184. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003219----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003220
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003221Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003222 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3223 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3224 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3225 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003226
3227A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3228connections.
3229
3230A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3231to forward incoming connections.
3232
3233A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3234parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3235
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003236A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3237ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3238sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3239the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3240explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3241from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3242"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3243for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3244to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3245optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3246are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3247any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3248names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3249that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3250duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3251names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3252
3253Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3254settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3255of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3256profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3257timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003259All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3260'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3261case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3262
3263Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3264logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3265proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3266However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3267name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3268
3269Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3270and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003271bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003272protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3273modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3274arbitrary criteria.
3275
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003276In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3277a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003278the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003279
3280 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3281 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3282 between responses and new requests.
3283
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003284 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3285 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3286 client-facing connection remains open.
3287
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003288 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3289 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003290
3291The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3292frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3293following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003294weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003295
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003296 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003297
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003298 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3299 ----+-----+-----+----
3300 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3301 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003302 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3303 ----+-----+-----+----
3304 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003305
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003306It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3307only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3308into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3309as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3310content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3311and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3312possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003313
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003314There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3315first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3316processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3317second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3318protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3319is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3320new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3321to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3322process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3323already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3324HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3325evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3326one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3327
3328There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3329performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3330tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3331preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3332analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3333HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3334header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3335mitigate this drawback.
3336
3337It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3338method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3339set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3340in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3341is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3342to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3343above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3344to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3345"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3346frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3347frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3348as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3349upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3350on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3351the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3352upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3353frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3354remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3357--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003359The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3360limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3361they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3362limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003363marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003364option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003365and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3366with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3367specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003369
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003370 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3371------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3372acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003373backlog X X X -
3374balance X - X X
3375bind - X X -
3376bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003377capture cookie - X X -
3378capture request header - X X -
3379capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003380clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3381clitcpka-idle X X X -
3382clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003383compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003384cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003385declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003386default-server X - X X
3387default_backend X X X -
3388description - X X X
3389disabled X X X X
3390dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003391email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003392email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003393email-alert mailers X X X X
3394email-alert myhostname X X X X
3395email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003396enabled X X X X
3397errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003398errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003399errorloc X X X X
3400errorloc302 X X X X
3401-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3402errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003403force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003404filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003405fullconn X - X X
3406grace X X X X
3407hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003408http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003409http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003410http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003411http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003412http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003413http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003414http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003415http-check set-var X - X X
3416http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003417http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003418http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003419http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003420http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003421http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003422id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003423ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003424load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003425log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003426log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003427log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003428log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003429max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003430maxconn X X X -
3431mode X X X X
3432monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003433monitor-uri X X X -
3434option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3435option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3436option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3437option allbackups (*) X - X X
3438option checkcache (*) X - X X
3439option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3440option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003441option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003442option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3443option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003444-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3445option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003446option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3447option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003448option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003449option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003450option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003451option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003452option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003453option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3454option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3455option httpchk X - X X
3456option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003457option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003458option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003459option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003460option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003461option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003462option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3463option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3464option logasap (*) X X X -
3465option mysql-check X - X X
3466option nolinger (*) X X X X
3467option originalto X X X X
3468option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003469option pgsql-check X - X X
3470option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003471option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003472option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003473option smtpchk X - X X
3474option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3475option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3476option splice-request (*) X X X X
3477option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003478option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003479option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3480option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3481-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003482option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003483option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3484option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3485option tcpka X X X X
3486option tcplog X X X X
3487option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003488external-check command X - X X
3489external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003490persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3491rate-limit sessions X X X -
3492redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003493-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003494retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003495retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003496server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003497server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003498server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003499source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003500srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3501srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3502srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003503stats admin - X X X
3504stats auth X X X X
3505stats enable X X X X
3506stats hide-version X X X X
3507stats http-request - X X X
3508stats realm X X X X
3509stats refresh X X X X
3510stats scope X X X X
3511stats show-desc X X X X
3512stats show-legends X X X X
3513stats show-node X X X X
3514stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003515-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3516stick match - - X X
3517stick on - - X X
3518stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003519stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003520stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003521tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003522tcp-check connect X - X X
3523tcp-check expect X - X X
3524tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003525tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003526tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003527tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003528tcp-check set-var X - X X
3529tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003530tcp-request connection - X X -
3531tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003532tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003533tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003534tcp-response content - - X X
3535tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003536timeout check X - X X
3537timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003538timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003539timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003540timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3541timeout http-request X X X X
3542timeout queue X - X X
3543timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003544timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003546timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003547transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003548unique-id-format X X X -
3549unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003550use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003551use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003552use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003553------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3554 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3558---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003559
3560This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3561
3562
3563acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3564 Declare or complete an access list.
3565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3566 no | yes | yes | yes
3567 Example:
3568 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3569 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3570 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003572 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003573
3574
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003575backlog <conns>
3576 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3578 yes | yes | yes | no
3579 Arguments :
3580 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3581 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003582 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003583
3584 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3585 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3586 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3587 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3588 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3589 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3590 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3591 backlog parameter.
3592
3593 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3594 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3595 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3596
3597 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3598
3599
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003601balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003602 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | no | yes | yes
3605 Arguments :
3606 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3607 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3608 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3609 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3610
3611 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3612 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3613 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3614 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003615 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003616 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003617 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3618 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3619 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3620 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3621 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3622 it, so that you don't worry.
3623
3624 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3625 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3626 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3627 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3628 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3629 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3630 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3631 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003633 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3634 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3635 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3636 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3637 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3638 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3639 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003640 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3641 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3642 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003643
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003644 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003645 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003646 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3647 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003648 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003649 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3650 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3651 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3652 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3653 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003654 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3655 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3656 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3657 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3658 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3659 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003661 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3662 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3663 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3664 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3665 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3666 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3667 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3668 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003669 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003671 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3672 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3673 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003675 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3676 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3677 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3678 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3679 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3680 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3681 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3682 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3683 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3684 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3685 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3686 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003688 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003689 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3690 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3691 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3692 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3693 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3694 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3695 URIs start with a leading "/".
3696
3697 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3698 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3699 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3700 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3701
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003702 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3703 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3704 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3705 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003707 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003708 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3709
3710 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003711 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3712 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003713 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3714 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3715 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3716 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003717 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003718 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3719 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003720
3721 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3722 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3723 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3724 server will receive the request.
3725
3726 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3727 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3728 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3729 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3730 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003731 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3732 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3733 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003734
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003735 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3736 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3737 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3738 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3739 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003741 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003742 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3743 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3744 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3745
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003746 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3747 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3748 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3749
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003750 random
3751 random(<draws>)
3752 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003753 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3754 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3755 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3756 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003757 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3758 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3759 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3760 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3761 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3762 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3763 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3764 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3765 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3766 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3767 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3768 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3769 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3770 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3771 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3772 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3773 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3774 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3775 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3776 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003777
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003778 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003779 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003780 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3781 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3782 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3783 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3784 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3785 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003786 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003787 used instead.
3788
3789 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3790 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3791 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3792 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3793
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003794 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3795 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3796 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3797
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003798 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003800 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003801 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3802 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003803
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003804 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3805 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3806 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003807
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003808 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003809 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003810 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3811 NTLM relies on.
3812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003813 Examples :
3814 balance roundrobin
3815 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003816 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003817 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3818 balance hdr(host)
3819 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003820
3821 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3822 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003824 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003825 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3826 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3827 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003828 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003829
3830 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3831 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3832 defaults to 16 kB.
3833
3834 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3835 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3836
3837 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3838 Round Robin.
3839
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003840 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003841 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3842 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3843 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3844
3845 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3846
3847 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003848 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003849 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3850 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3851 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003852
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003853 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003854
3855
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003856bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3857bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003858 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3860 no | yes | yes | no
3861 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003862 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3863 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3864 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3865 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003866 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003867 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3868 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3869 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3870 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3871 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3872 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003873 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003874 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3875 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003876 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003877 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3878 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003879 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003880 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3881 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003882 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003883 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3884 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3885 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3886 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3887 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3888 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3889 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003890 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3891 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3892 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003893 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3894 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3895 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3896 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003897 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3898 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3899 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003900
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003901 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3902 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003903 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3904 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3905 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003906 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3907 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3908 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3909 the range.
3910
3911 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3912 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3913 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3914 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3915 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3916 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3917 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003918 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003919 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003920
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003921 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003922 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003923 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3924 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3925 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3926 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3927 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3928 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3929
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003930 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3931 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3932 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3933 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003935 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3936 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3937 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3938 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3939 in a frontend.
3940
3941 Example :
3942 listen http_proxy
3943 bind :80,:443
3944 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003945 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003947 listen http_https_proxy
3948 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003949 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003950
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003951 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3952 bind ipv6@:80
3953 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3954 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3955
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003956 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003957 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003958
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003959 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3960 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3961 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3962 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3963 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3964
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003965 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003966 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003967
3968
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003969bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003970 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3972 yes | yes | yes | yes
3973 Arguments :
3974 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3975 may be used to override a default value.
3976
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003977 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003978 option may be combined with other numbers.
3979
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003980 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003981 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3982 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3983 missing from all processes.
3984
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003985 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003986 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003987 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3988 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3989 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3990 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3991 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003992 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003993
3994 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3995 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3996 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3997 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3998 and 'even' instances.
3999
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004000 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4001 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4002 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4003 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004004
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004005 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4006 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4007
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004008 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4009 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4010 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4011
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004012 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4013 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4014
4015 Example :
4016 listen app_ip1
4017 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004018 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004019
4020 listen app_ip2
4021 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004022 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004023
4024 listen management
4025 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004026 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004027
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004028 listen management
4029 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4030 bind-process 1-4
4031
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004032 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004033
4034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004035capture cookie <name> len <length>
4036 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4038 no | yes | yes | no
4039 Arguments :
4040 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4041 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4042 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4043 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004044 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004045
4046 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4047 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4048 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4049 right if it exceeds <length>.
4050
4051 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4052 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4053 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4054 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4055
4056 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4057 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4058 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4059
4060 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4061 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4062 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004063 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4064 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4065 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004066
4067 Example:
4068 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4069
4070 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004071 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004072
4073
4074capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004075 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4077 no | yes | yes | no
4078 Arguments :
4079 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004080 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004081 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4082 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4083 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4084
4085 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4086 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4087 it exceeds <length>.
4088
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004089 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4091 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004092 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4093 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4094 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4095 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004096 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004097 environments to find where the request came from.
4098
4099 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4100 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4101 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4102 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004103
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004104 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4105 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4106 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4107 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4108 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109
4110 Example:
4111 capture request header Host len 15
4112 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004113 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004115 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004116 about logging.
4117
4118
4119capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004120 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4122 no | yes | yes | no
4123 Arguments :
4124 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004125 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4127 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4128 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4129
4130 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4131 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4132 it exceeds <length>.
4133
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004134 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004135 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4136 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4137 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004138 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4139 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4140 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4141 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004142
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004143 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4144 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4145 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4146 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4147 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004148
4149 Example:
4150 capture response header Content-length len 9
4151 capture response header Location len 15
4152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004153 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004154 about logging.
4155
4156
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004157clitcpka-cnt <count>
4158 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4159 the connection on the client side.
4160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 yes | yes | yes | no
4162 Arguments :
4163 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4164
4165 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4166 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004167 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4168 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004169
4170 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4171
4172
4173clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4174 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4175 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4176 client side.
4177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4178 yes | yes | yes | no
4179 Arguments :
4180 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4181 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4182 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4183 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4184
4185 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4186 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004187 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4188 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004189
4190 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4191
4192
4193clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4194 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4196 yes | yes | yes | no
4197 Arguments :
4198 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4199 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4200 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4201 document.
4202
4203 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4204 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004205 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4206 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004207
4208 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4209
4210
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004211compression algo <algorithm> ...
4212compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004213compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004214 Enable HTTP compression.
4215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 yes | yes | yes | yes
4217 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004218 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4219 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4220 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4221
4222 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004223 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4224 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4225 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004226
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004227 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004228 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004229
4230 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4231 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4232 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4233 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4234 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004235 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004236
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004237 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4238 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4239 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4240 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4241 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4242 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4243 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004244 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004245
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004246 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004247 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004248 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4249 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4250 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4251 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4252 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004253
4254 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4255 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4256 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4257 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4258 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004259 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4260 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4261 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4262 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4263 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004264 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4265 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004266
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004267 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004268 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4269 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004270 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004271 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004272 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4273 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4274 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4275 "multipart"
4276 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4277 header
4278 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4279 and later
4280 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4281 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004282 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004283
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004284 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004285
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004286 Examples :
4287 compression algo gzip
4288 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004289
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004290
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004291cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004292 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4293 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004294 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004295 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 yes | no | yes | yes
4298 Arguments :
4299 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4300 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4301 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4302 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4303 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4304 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004305 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004306 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4307 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4308
4309 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4310 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4311 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4312 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4313 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4314 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004315 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4316 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004317 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004318 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4319 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
4321 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004322 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004323
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004324 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004325 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004326 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004327 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004328 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4329 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4330 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4331 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4332 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4333 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4334 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004335
4336 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4337 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4338 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4339 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4340 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4341 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4342 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4343 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4344 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004345 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004346 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4347 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4348 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004350 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4351 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4352 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004353 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4354 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4355 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4356 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004357 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4358 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4359 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004360
4361 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4362 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4363 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4364 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4365 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4366 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4367 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4368 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4369 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4370
4371 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4372 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4373 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4374 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4375 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4376 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4377 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4378 persistence cookie in the cache.
4379 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4380
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004381 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4382 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4383 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4384 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4385 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004386 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004387 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4388 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4389 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4390 they logout.
4391
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004392 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4393 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4394 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4395 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4396
4397 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4398 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4399 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4400 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4401 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4402 this attribute.
4403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004404 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004405 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004406 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4407 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4408 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4409 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4410 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4411 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004412
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004413 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4414 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4415 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4416 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4417 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4418 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4419 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4420 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004421 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004422 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4423 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4424 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4425 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4426 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4427 the site.
4428
4429 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4430 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4431 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4432 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4433 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4434 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4435 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4436 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4437 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4438 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4439 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4440 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4441 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004442 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004443 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4444 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4445
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004446 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4447 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4448 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4449 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4450 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4451 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4452
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004453 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4454 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4455 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4456 repeated.
4457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004458 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4459 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4460 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4461 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463 Examples :
4464 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4465 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4466 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004467 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004468
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004469 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004470
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004471
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004472declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4473 Declares a capture slot.
4474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4475 no | yes | yes | no
4476 Arguments:
4477 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4478
4479 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4480 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4481 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4482 for use in the response.
4483
4484 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004485 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004486 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4487
4488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004489default-server [param*]
4490 Change default options for a server in a backend
4491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4492 yes | no | yes | yes
4493 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004494 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4495 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4496 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4497 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004498
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004499 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004500 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4501
4502 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004503
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004505default_backend <backend>
4506 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 yes | yes | yes | no
4509 Arguments :
4510 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4511
4512 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4513 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4514 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4515 will catch all undetermined requests.
4516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517 Example :
4518
4519 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4520 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4521 default_backend dynamic
4522
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004523 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004525
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004526description <string>
4527 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 no | yes | yes | yes
4530 Arguments : string
4531
4532 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4533 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4534 it describes.
4535 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4536
4537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004538disabled
4539 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 yes | yes | yes | yes
4542 Arguments : none
4543
4544 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4545 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4546 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4547 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4548 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4549 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4550 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4551
4552 See also : "enabled"
4553
4554
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004555dispatch <address>:<port>
4556 Set a default server address
4557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4558 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004559 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004560
4561 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4562 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4563 during start-up.
4564
4565 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4566 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4567 possible with normal servers.
4568
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004569 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004570 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4571 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4572 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4573 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4574
4575 See also : "server"
4576
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004577
4578dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4579 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | no | yes | yes
4582 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4583
4584 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004585 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004586 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4587 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004588 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004589 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004591enabled
4592 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4594 yes | yes | yes | yes
4595 Arguments : none
4596
4597 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4598 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4599
4600 See also : "disabled"
4601
4602
4603errorfile <code> <file>
4604 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4606 yes | yes | yes | yes
4607 Arguments :
4608 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004609 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004610 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004611
4612 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004613 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004614 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004615 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4616 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004617
4618 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4619 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4620 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4621
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004622 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4623
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004624 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4625 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4626 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4627 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4628 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4629 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4630 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4631 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4632 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004634 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4635 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4636 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004637 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004638 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4639
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004640 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004641
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004642 Example :
4643 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004644 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004645 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4646 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004648
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004649errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4650 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4651 section.
4652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4653 yes | yes | yes | yes
4654 Arguments :
4655 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4656
4657 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004658 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004659 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4660 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004661
4662 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4663 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4664 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4665 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4666 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004667 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004668 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4669
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004670 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4671 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004672
4673 Example :
4674 errorfiles generic
4675 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4676
4677
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004678errorloc <code> <url>
4679errorloc302 <code> <url>
4680 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4682 yes | yes | yes | yes
4683 Arguments :
4684 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004685 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004686 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004687
4688 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4689 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4690 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4691 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004692 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004693
4694 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4695 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4696 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4697
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004698 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004700 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4701 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4702 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4703 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004704 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004705 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4706 request.
4707
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004708 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004709
4710
4711errorloc303 <code> <url>
4712 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4714 yes | yes | yes | yes
4715 Arguments :
4716 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004717 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004718 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719
4720 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4721 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4722 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4723 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004724 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004725
4726 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4727 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4728 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4729
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004730 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004732 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4733 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4734 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4735 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004736 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004737
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004738 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739
4740
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004741email-alert from <emailaddr>
4742 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004743 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4745 yes | yes | yes | yes
4746
4747 Arguments :
4748
4749 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4750
4751 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4752 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4753
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004754 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004755 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4756 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004757
4758
4759email-alert level <level>
4760 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4761 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4762 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4763 yes | yes | yes | yes
4764
4765 Arguments :
4766
4767 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4768 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4769 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4770
4771 By default level is alert
4772
4773 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4774 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4775 for the proxy.
4776
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004777 Alerts are sent when :
4778
4779 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4780 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4781 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4782 is notice or lower
4783 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4784 and a health check status update occurs
4785
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004786 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4787 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004788 section 3.6 about mailers.
4789
4790
4791email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4792 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4794 yes | yes | yes | yes
4795
4796 Arguments :
4797
4798 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4799
4800 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4801 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4802
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004803 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4804 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004805
4806
4807email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4808 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4809 mailers.
4810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | yes | yes | yes
4812
4813 Arguments :
4814
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004815 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004816
4817 By default the systems hostname is used.
4818
4819 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4820 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4821 for the proxy.
4822
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004823 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4824 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004825
4826
4827email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004828 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004829 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4831 yes | yes | yes | yes
4832
4833 Arguments :
4834
4835 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4836
4837 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4838 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4839
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004840 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004841 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4842
4843
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004844force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4845 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004847 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004848
4849 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4850 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4851 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4852 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4853 marked down for maintenance operations.
4854
4855 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4856 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4857 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4858 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4859 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4860 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4861 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4862 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4863 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4864
4865 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4866 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4867 is used.
4868
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004869 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004870 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004871
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004872
4873filter <name> [param*]
4874 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4876 no | yes | yes | yes
4877 Arguments :
4878 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4879 referenced in section 9.
4880
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004881 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004882 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004883 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4884 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004885
4886 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4887 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4888
4889 Example:
4890 listen
4891 bind *:80
4892
4893 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4894 filter compression
4895 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4896
4897 compression algo gzip
4898 compression offload
4899
4900 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4901
4902 See also : section 9.
4903
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004904
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004905fullconn <conns>
4906 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4908 yes | no | yes | yes
4909 Arguments :
4910 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4911 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4912
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004913 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004914 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004915 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004916 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4917 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4918 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4919 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4920 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004921 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004922
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004923 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4924 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004925 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4926 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4927 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004928
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004929 Example :
4930 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4931 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4932 # connections.
4933 backend dynamic
4934 fullconn 10000
4935 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4936 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4937
4938 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4939
4940
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004941grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004942 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004944 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004945 Arguments :
4946 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4947 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4948 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4949
4950 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4951 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004952 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004953 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4954
4955 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4956 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4957 simplify it.
4958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004959
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004960hash-balance-factor <factor>
4961 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | no | no | yes
4964 Arguments :
4965 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4966 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004967 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004968
4969 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4970 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4971 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4972 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4973 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4974 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4975 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4976
4977 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4978 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4979 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4980 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4981 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4982
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004983 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4984 consistent hashing mechanism.
4985
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004986 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4987
4988
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004989hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004990 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4992 yes | no | yes | yes
4993 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004994 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4995 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004996
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004997 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4998 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4999 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5000 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5001 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5002 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5003 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5004 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5005 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5006 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005007
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005008 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5009 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5010 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5011 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5012 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5013 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5014 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5015 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5016 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5017 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5018 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5019 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5020 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005021 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5022 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005023
5024 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5025
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005026 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005027 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5028 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5029 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005030 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5031 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5032 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005033
5034 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5035 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005036 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5037 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5038 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5039 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5040
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005041 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5042 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5043 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5044 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5045 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5046 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5047 parameter.
5048
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005049 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5050 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5051 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5052 used on strings.
5053
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005054 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5055
5056 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5057 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5058 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5059 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5060 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5061 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5062 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5063 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5064 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5065 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5066 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5067 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005068
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005069 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5070 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5071 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005072
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005073 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005074
5075
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005076http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5077 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5078 ones).
5079
5080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5081 no | yes | yes | yes
5082
5083 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5084 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5085 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5086 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5087 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5088 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5089
5090 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5091 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5092 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5093
5094 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5095 below.
5096
5097 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5098 instance.
5099
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005100 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5101 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5102 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5103
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005104 Example:
5105 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5106 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5107 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5108
5109http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5110
5111 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5112 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5113 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5114 example, or to pass some internal information.
5115 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5116 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5117 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5118
5119http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5120
5121 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5122 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5123
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005124http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005125
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005126 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5127 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5128 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5129 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5130 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005131
5132http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5133 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5134
5135 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5136
5137 Example:
5138 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5139
5140 # applied to:
5141 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5142
5143 # outputs:
5144 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5145
5146 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5147
5148http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5150
5151 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5152
5153 Example:
5154 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5155
5156 # applied to:
5157 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5158
5159 # outputs:
5160 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5161
5162http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5163
5164 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5165 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5166 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5167
5168http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5169 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5170
5171 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5172 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5173 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5174 fallback.
5175
5176 Example:
5177 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5178 http-response set-status 431
5179 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5180 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5181
5182http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5183
5184 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5185 inline.
5186
5187 Arguments:
5188 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5189 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5190 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5191 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5192 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5193 (request and response)
5194 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5195 processing
5196 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5197 processing
5198 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5199 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5200 and '_'.
5201
5202 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5203 followed by some converters.
5204
5205 Example:
5206 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5207
5208http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5209
5210 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5211 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5212 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5213 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5214 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005215 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005216 processing.
5217
5218 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5219 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005220 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005221 rules evaluation.
5222
5223http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5224
5225 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5226 details about <var-name>.
5227
5228 Example:
5229 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5230
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005231
5232http-check comment <string>
5233 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5234 it fails.
5235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5236 yes | no | yes | yes
5237
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005238 Arguments :
5239 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5240 rule fails.
5241
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005242 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5243 user-friendly error reporting.
5244
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005245 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005246 "http-check expect".
5247
5248
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005249http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5250 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005251 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005252 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5254 yes | no | yes | yes
5255
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005256 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005257 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5258
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005259 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005260 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005261
5262 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5263 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5264 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5265 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5266
5267 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5268
5269 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5270
5271 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5272
5273 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5274
5275 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5276
5277 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5278 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5279 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5280 is used.
5281
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005282 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5283 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5284 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5285 haproxy -vv.
5286
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005287 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5288
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005289 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5290 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5291 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5292 different ports or with different servers.
5293
5294 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5295 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5296 the port with a "http-check connect".
5297
5298 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5299 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5300 do.
5301
5302 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5303 unset-var or comment rules.
5304
5305 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005306 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5307 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5308 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5309 option httpchk
5310
5311 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005312 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005313 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005314 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005315 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005316 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005317
5318 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5319
5320 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005321
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005323http-check disable-on-404
5324 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005326 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005327 Arguments : none
5328
5329 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5330 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5331 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5332 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5333 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5334 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5335 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5336 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005337 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5338 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005339 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5340 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5341 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005342
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005343 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005344
5345
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005346http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005347 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5348 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5349 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005350 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005352 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005353
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005354 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005355 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5356
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005357 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5358 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5359 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5360 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5361 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5362 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5363 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5364 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5365 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5366 result is always conclusive.
5367
5368 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5369 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5370 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005371 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5372 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005373 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5374 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005375 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5376 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5377 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005378
5379 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5380 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005381 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5382 supported :
5383 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5384 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005385 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5386 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5387 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5388 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5389 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005390
5391 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5392 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005393 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5394 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5395 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5396 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005397 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5398
5399 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5400 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5401 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5402 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5403
5404 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5405 informational message reported in logs if an error
5406 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5407 log-format string.
5408
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005409 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005410 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5411 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005412 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5413 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5414 details on the supported keywords.
5415
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005416 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5417 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5418 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5419 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005420
5421 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5422 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5423 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5424 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5425 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5426
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005427 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5428 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5429 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5430 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5431 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5432 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5433 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005434
5435 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005436 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005437 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5438 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5439 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5440 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5441
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005442 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5443 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005444 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5445 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5446 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5447 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5448 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5449 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5450 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5451 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005452 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5453 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5454 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5455 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5456 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5457 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5458 insensitive on the header names.
5459
5460 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5461 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5462 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5463 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5464 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5465 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005466
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005467 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005468 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005469 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5470 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5471 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5472 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5473 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005474 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005475 trace).
5476
5477 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005478 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005479 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5480 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5481 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5482 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5483 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005484 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005485
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005486 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5487 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5488 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5489 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5490 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5491 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5492
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005493 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005494 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005495 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5496 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5497 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5498 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5499 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5500 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5501
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005502 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5503 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5504 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5505 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5506 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005507
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005508 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5509 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5510
5511 Examples :
5512 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005513 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005514
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005515 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5516 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5517
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005518 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005519 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005520
5521 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005522 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005523
5524 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005525 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005526
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005527 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005528 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005529
5530
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005531http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005532 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5533 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005534 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5535 health checks.
5536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5537 yes | no | yes | yes
5538 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005539 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5540
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005541 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5542 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5543 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5544 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5545 to invent non-standard ones.
5546
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005547 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5548 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5549 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5550 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5551
5552 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5553 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5554 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5555 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005556
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005557 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005558 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005559 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005560 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5561 to add it.
5562
5563 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5564 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5565 to the log-format rules.
5566
5567 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5568 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5569 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005570
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005571 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5572 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5573 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5574 request.
5575
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005576 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5577 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5578 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005579 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5580 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5581 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5582 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005583 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005584
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005585 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005586 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5587 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005588
5589 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5590 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5591 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5592 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5593 configured request authority.
5594
5595 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5596 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005597
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005598 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005599
5600
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005601http-check send-state
5602 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 yes | no | yes | yes
5605 Arguments : none
5606
5607 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5608 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5609 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5610 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5611 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5612
5613 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5614 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5615 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5616 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5617 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005618 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5619 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5620 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5621
5622 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5623 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5624 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5625
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005626 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5627 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5628 checked in multiple backends.
5629
5630 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5631 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5632
5633 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5634 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5635 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5636 one fails.
5637
5638 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5639 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5640 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5641
5642 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5643 server's queue.
5644
5645 Example of a header received by the application server :
5646 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5647 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5648
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005649 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5650 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005651
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005652
5653http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005654 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5656 yes | no | yes | yes
5657
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005658 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005659 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5660 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5661 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5662 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5663 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5665 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5666 and '-'.
5667
5668 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5669
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005670 Examples :
5671 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005672
5673
5674http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005675 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 yes | no | yes | yes
5678
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005679 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005680 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5681 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5684 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5685 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5686 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5687 and '-'.
5688
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005689 Examples :
5690 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005692
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005693http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5694 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5695 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5696 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5697 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5699 yes | yes | yes | yes
5700 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005701 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005702 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005703 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005704 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005705
5706 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5707 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5708 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5709 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5710
5711 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5712 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5713 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5714 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5715
5716 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5717 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5718 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5719 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5720 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5721 chroot is performed.
5722
5723 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5724 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5725 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5726 considered.
5727
5728 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5729 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5730 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5731 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5732 considered as a raw string.
5733
5734 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5735 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5736 "content-type".
5737
5738 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5739 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5740 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5741 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5742 evaluated as a log-format string.
5743
5744 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5745 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5746 argument to "content-type".
5747
5748 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5749 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5750 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5751 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5752
5753 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5754 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5755 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5756 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5757 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5758 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5759 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5760 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5761
5762 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5763 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5764 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5765
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005766 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5767 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5768 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5769 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5770 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5771
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005772 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5773 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5774
5775
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005776http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005777 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5778
5779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5780 no | yes | yes | yes
5781
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005782 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5783 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5784 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5785 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5786 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005788 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5789 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005791 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005793 Example:
5794 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5795 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5796 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005798 http-request allow if nagios
5799 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5800 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5801 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005803 Example:
5804 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5805 acl add path /addacl
5806 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005808 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005810 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5811 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005813 Example:
5814 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5815 acl setmap path /setmap
5816 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005818 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005820 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5821 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005823 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5824 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005826http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005828 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5829 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5830 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5831 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5832 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5833 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5834 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5835 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005837http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005839 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5840 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5841 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5842 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5843 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5844 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5845 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5846 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005848http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005850 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5851 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005852
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005854http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005855
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005856 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5857 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5858 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5859 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5860 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005861
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005862 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5863 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5864 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5865 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5866 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5867 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5868 instead.
5869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005870 Example:
5871 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5872 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005873
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005874http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005875
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005876 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005878http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5879 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005881 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5882 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5883 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5884 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5885 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5886 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5887 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5888 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5889 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005891 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5892 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5893 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005894 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5895
5896 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5897 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5898 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5899 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005901http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5904 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5905 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5906 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5907 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5908 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005909
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005910http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005911
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005912 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5913 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5914 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5915 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5916 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005918http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5921 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5922 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5923 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5924 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5925 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005926
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005927http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5928http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5929 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5930 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5931 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5932 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005933
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005934 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5935 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5936 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005937 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005938 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5939 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5940 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005941 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005942 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005943
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005944http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5945 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5946 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5947 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5948
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005949http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5950
5951 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5952 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5953 pointed by <resolvers>.
5954 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5955 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5956 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5957 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5958 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5959 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5960 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5961 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5962 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5963 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5964 to 0.0.0.0.
5965
5966 Example:
5967 resolvers mydns
5968 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5969 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5970 timeout retry 1s
5971 hold valid 10s
5972 hold nx 3s
5973 hold other 3s
5974 hold obsolete 0s
5975 accepted_payload_size 8192
5976
5977 frontend fe
5978 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5979 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5980 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5981
5982 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5983 # which mean DNS resolution error
5984 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5985
5986 default_backend be
5987
5988 backend b_503
5989 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5990 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5991 # 503 error page to end users
5992
5993 backend be
5994 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5995 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5996 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5997 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5998 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5999
6000 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6001 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6002
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006003http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6004
6005 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6006 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6007 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6008 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006009 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6010 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006011
6012 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6013
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006014http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006015http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6016http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6017http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6018http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006019
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006020 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6021
6022 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6023 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6024 the supported backend.
6025
6026 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6027 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6028 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6029 number of segments in the path.
6030
6031 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006032
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006033 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component.
6034 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
6035 their preceding segment. Empty segments do not receive special treatment.
6036 Use the "path-merge-slashes" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006037
6038 Example:
6039 - /foo/../ -> /
6040 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6041 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6042 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006043 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006044 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
6045
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006046 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6047 removed as well:
6048
6049 Example:
6050 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6051 - /bar/../../ -> /
6052
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006053 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6054 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006055
6056 Example:
6057 - // -> /
6058 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6059
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006060 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006061 (RFC 3986#6.2.21).
6062
6063 Example:
6064 - /%6f -> /%6F
6065 - /%zz -> /%zz
6066
6067 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6068 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6069
6070 Example:
6071 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6072
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006073 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006074 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6075 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6076
6077 Example:
6078 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6079 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6080 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006082http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006084 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6085 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6086 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6087 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6088 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006090http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006092 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6093 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6094 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6095 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6098 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006099
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006100 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006101 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6102 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6103 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6104 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6105 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006106
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006107 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6108 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6109 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6110 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6111 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006112
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006113 Example:
6114 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6115
6116 # applied to:
6117 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6118
6119 # outputs:
6120 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6121
6122 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006123
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006124 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6125
6126 # applied to:
6127 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006128
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006129 # outputs:
6130 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006131
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006132http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6133 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6134
6135 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6136 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006137 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6138 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6139 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006140
6141 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6142 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6143 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6144
6145 Example:
6146 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6147 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6148
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006149 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6150 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6151 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6152 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6153
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006154http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6155 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6156
6157 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6158 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6159 query-string are replaced.
6160
6161 Example:
6162 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6163 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6164
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006165http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6166 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6167
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006168 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6169 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6170 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6171 against.
6172
6173 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6174 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6175 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006176
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006177 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6178 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6179 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6180 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6181 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6182 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6183 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6184 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6185 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006186 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6187 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006188
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006189 Example:
6190 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6191 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006192
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006193 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6194 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006196http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6197 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006198
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006199 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6200 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6201 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6202 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006203
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006204 Example:
6205 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006206
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006207 # applied to:
6208 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006209
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006210 # outputs:
6211 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006212
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006213http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6214 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6215 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006216 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006217 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6218
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006219 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006220 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6221 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006222 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006223 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006224 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006225 are followed to create the response :
6226
6227 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6228 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6229 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6230 ignored.
6231
6232 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6233 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006234 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006235 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6236 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006237
6238 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6239 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6240 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006241 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6242 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006243
6244 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6245 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6246 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006247 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006248 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006249 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006250
6251 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6252 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6253 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6254 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6255 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6256 as a raw content.
6257
6258 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6259 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6260 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6261 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6262 considered as a raw string.
6263
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006264 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006265 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6266 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6267 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6268
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006269 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6270 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006271 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006272
6273 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6274
6275 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006276 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006277 if { path /ping }
6278
6279 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6280 if { path /favicon.ico }
6281
6282 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6283 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6284 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006286http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6287http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006289 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6290 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6291 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006292
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006293http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6294 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006295
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006296 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6297 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6298 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6299 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006301http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006303 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6304 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6305 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6306 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6307 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006309 Arguments:
6310 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6311 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006313 Example:
6314 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6315 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006317 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6318 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006320http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006322 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6323 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6324 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006326 Arguments:
6327 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6328 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006330 Example:
6331 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6332 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006334 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6335 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6336 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006338http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006340 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6341 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6342 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6343 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6344 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006346 Example:
6347 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6348 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6349 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6350 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6351 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6352 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6353 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6354 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6355 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006357http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006359 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6360 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6361 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6362 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6363 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006365http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006368 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6369 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6370 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6371 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6372 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6373 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6374 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6375 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6376 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006378http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006380 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6381 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6382 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6383 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6384 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6385 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6386 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006388http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006390 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6391 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6392 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006394http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006396 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6397 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6398 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6399 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6400 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6401 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6402 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6403 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006405http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006407 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6408 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6409 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6410 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6411 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6412 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006414 Example :
6415 # prepend the host name before the path
6416 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006417
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006418http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6419
6420 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6421 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6422 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006424http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006426 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6427 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6428 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6429 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6430 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006432http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006434 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6435 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6436 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6437 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6438 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6439 values have higher priority.
6440 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6441 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6442 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6443 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6444 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006446http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006448 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6449 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6450 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6451 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6452 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6453 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6454 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006456 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006457
6458 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006459 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6460 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006462http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6463 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6464 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6465 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006466 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6467 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006468
6469 Arguments :
6470 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6471 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006472
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006473 See also "option forwardfor".
6474
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006475 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006476 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6477 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6478
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006479 # After the masking this will track connections
6480 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6481 http-request track-sc0 src
6482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006483 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6484 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6485
6486http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6487
6488 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6489 expression.
6490
6491 Arguments:
6492 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6493 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006494
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006495 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006496 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6497 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6498
6499 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6500 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6501 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6502
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006503http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6504 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6505
6506 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6507 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6508 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6509 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6510 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6511
6512 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6513 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6514 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6515 results.
6516
6517 Example:
6518 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6519 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006521http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6522
6523 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6524 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6525 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6526 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6527 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6528 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6529 information from the request.
6530
6531 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6532
6533http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6534
6535 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6536 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6537 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6538 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6539 path and the query string.
6540 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6541
6542http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6543
6544 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6545 inline.
6546
6547 Arguments:
6548 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6549 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6550 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6551 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6552 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6553 (request and response)
6554 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6555 processing
6556 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6557 processing
6558 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6559 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6560 and '_'.
6561
6562 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6563 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006564
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006565 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006566 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006568http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6569 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006571 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6572 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6573 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6574 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6575 agent name must be used.
6576
6577 Arguments:
6578 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6579
6580 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6581 configuration.
6582
6583http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6584
6585 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6586 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6587 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6588 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6589 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6590 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6591 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6592 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6593 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6594 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6595 action.
6596 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6597 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6598 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6599 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6600 you fully understand how it works.
6601
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006602http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6603
6604 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6605 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6606 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6607 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6608 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006609 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006610 processing.
6611
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006612 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006613 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6614 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6615 rules evaluation.
6616
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006617http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6618http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6619 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6620 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6621 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6622 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006623
6624 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6625 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6626 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006627 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6628 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6629 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6630 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6631 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6632 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6633 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6634 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6635 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6636 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006637 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006638 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6639 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6640 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6641 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6642 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643
6644http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6645http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6646http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6647
6648 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6649 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6650 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6651 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006652 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006653 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6654 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6655 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6656 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6657 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6658 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6659 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6660
6661 Arguments :
6662 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6663 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6664 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6665 select which table entry to update the counters.
6666
6667 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6668 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6669 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6670 that table until the session ends.
6671
6672 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6673 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6674 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6675 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6676 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6677 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6678 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6679 useful information.
6680
6681 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6682 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6683 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6684 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6685 checks that make use of it.
6686
6687http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6688
6689 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006690
6691 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006692 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006693
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006694http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6695
6696 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6697 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6698 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6699 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6700 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6701 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6702
6703 Arguments :
6704 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6705
6706 Example:
6707 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6708
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006709http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6710 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6711
6712 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6713 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6714 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6715 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6716 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6717 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6718 http-buffer-request".
6719
6720 Arguments :
6721
6722 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6723 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6724
6725 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
6726 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
6727 bytes.
6728
6729 Example:
6730 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6731
6732 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006734http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6737 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6738 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006739
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006741http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006742 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6743
6744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6745 no | yes | yes | yes
6746
6747 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6748 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6749 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6750 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6751 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6752 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006754 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6755 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006757 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006759 Example:
6760 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006762 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006763
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006764 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6765 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006766
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006767 Example:
6768 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006769
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006770 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006771
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006772 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6773 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006774
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006775 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6776 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006777
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006778http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006780 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6781 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6782 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6783 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6784 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6785 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6786 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6787 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006789http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006791 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6792 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6793 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6794 example, or to pass some internal information.
6795 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6796 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6797 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006798
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006799http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006800
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006801 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6802 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006803
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006804http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006805
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006806 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006807
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006808http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006809
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006810 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6811 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6812 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6813 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6814 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6815 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6816 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006817
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006818 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6819 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6820 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6821 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6822 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006823
6824 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6825 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6826 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6827 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006828
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006829http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006830
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006831 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6832 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6833 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6834 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6835 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6836 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006837
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006838http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006839
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006840 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6841 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6842 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6843 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6844 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006846http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006848 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6849 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6850 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6851 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6852 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6853 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006854
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006855http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6856http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6857 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6858 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6859 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6860 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006861
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006862 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6863 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6864 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006865 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006866 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6867 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6868 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006869 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006870 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006871
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006872http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006873
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006874 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6875 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6876 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6877 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6878 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6879 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006881http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6882 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006883
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006884 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6885 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006886
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006887 Example:
6888 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006890 # applied to:
6891 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006892
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006893 # outputs:
6894 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006896 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006898http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6899 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006900
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006901 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006902 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006904 Example:
6905 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006906
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006907 # applied to:
6908 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006910 # outputs:
6911 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006912
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006913http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6914 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6915 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006916 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006917 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6918
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006919 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006920 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6921 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006922 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006923 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006924 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006925 are followed to create the response :
6926
6927 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6928 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6929 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6930 ignored.
6931
6932 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6933 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006934 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006935 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6936 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006937
6938 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6939 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6940 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006941 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6942 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006943
6944 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6945 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6946 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006947 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006948 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006949 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006950
6951 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6952 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6953 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6954 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6955 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6956 as a raw content.
6957
6958 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6959 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6960 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6961 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6962 considered as a raw string.
6963
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006964 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6965 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6966 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6967 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6968
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006969 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6970 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006971 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006972
6973 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6974
6975 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006976 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006977 if { status eq 404 }
6978
6979 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6980 string "This is the end !" \
6981 if { status eq 500 }
6982
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006983http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6984http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006986 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6987 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6988 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006989
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006990http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6991 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006992
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006993 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6994 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6995 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6996 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006998http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006999
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007000 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7001 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7002 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7003 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7004 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007006 Arguments:
7007 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007009 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7010 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007012http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007014 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7015 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7016 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007018http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7019
7020 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7021 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7022 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7023 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7024 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7025
7026http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7027
7028 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7029 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7030 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7031 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7032 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7033 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7034 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7035 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7036 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7037
7038http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7039
7040 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7041 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7042 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7043 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7044 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7045 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7046 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7047
7048http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7049
7050 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7051 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7052 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7053 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7054 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7055 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7056 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7057 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7058
7059http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7060 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7061
7062 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7063 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7064 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7065 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007066
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007067 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7069 http-response set-status 431
7070 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7071 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007073http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007075 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7076 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7077 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7078 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7079 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7080 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7081 based on some information from the request.
7082
7083 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7084
7085http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7086
7087 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7088 inline.
7089
7090 Arguments:
7091 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7092 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7093 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7094 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7095 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7096 (request and response)
7097 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7098 processing
7099 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7100 processing
7101 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7102 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7103 and '_'.
7104
7105 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7106 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007107
7108 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007109 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007111http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007113 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7114 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7115 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7116 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7117 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7118 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7119 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7120 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7121 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7122 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7123 action.
7124 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7125 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7126 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7127 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7128 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007129
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007130http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7131
7132 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7133 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7134 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7135 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7136 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007137 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007138 processing.
7139
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007140 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007141 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007142 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007143 rules evaluation.
7144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007145http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7146http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7147http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007148
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007149 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7150 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7151 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7152 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7153 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7154 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7155
7156http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7157
7158 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7159 about <var-name>.
7160
7161 Example:
7162 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7163
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007164http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7165 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7166
7167 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7168 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7169 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7170 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7171 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7172 buffer is full.
7173
7174 Arguments :
7175
7176 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7177 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7178
7179 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
7180 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7181 bytes.
7182
7183 Example:
7184 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007185
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007186http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7187 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7188
7189 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7190 yes | no | yes | yes
7191
7192 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007193 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7194 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7195 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007196
7197 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7198
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007199 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7200 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7201 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7202 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7203 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7204 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7205 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7206 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7207 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7208 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007209
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007210 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7211 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7212 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7213 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7214 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7215 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7216 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007217 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7218 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7219 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7220 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7221 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7222 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007223
7224 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7225 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7226 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7227 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7228 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7229 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7230 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7231 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007232 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007233 downsides of rare connection failures.
7234
7235 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7236 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7237 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7238 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7239 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7240 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007241 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007242 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7243 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7244 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7245 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7246 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7247
7248 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007249 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7250 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7251 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7252 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007253
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007254 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7255 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007256
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007257 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007258
7259 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7260 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7261 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7262
7263 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7264
7265
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007266http-send-name-header [<header>]
7267 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007268 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7269 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007270 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007271 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7272
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007273 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7274 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7275 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7276 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7277 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7278 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7279 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7280 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7281 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7282 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7283 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7284 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7285 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7286 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7287 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7288 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007289
7290 See also : "server"
7291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007292id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007293 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7295 no | yes | yes | yes
7296 Arguments : none
7297
7298 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7299 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7300 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007301
7302
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007303ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7304 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007306 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007307
7308 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7309 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7310 and running).
7311
7312 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7313 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7314 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007315 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007316 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7317
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007318 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7319 "unless" condition is met.
7320
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007321 Example:
7322 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7323 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7324 ignore-persist if url_static
7325
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007326 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7327
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007328load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7329 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7331 yes | no | yes | yes
7332
7333 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7334 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7335 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007336 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007337 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7338 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7339 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7340 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7341
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007342 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007343 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007344 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007345
7346 Arguments:
7347 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7348 named "server-state-file".
7349
7350 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7351 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7352 name is used as a file name.
7353
7354 none don't load any stat for this backend
7355
7356 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007357 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7358 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7359 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007360 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007361 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007362
7363 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7364 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7365
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007366 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007367
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007368 global
7369 stats socket /tmp/socket
7370 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007371
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007372 defaults
7373 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007374
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007375 backend bk
7376 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7377 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007378
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007379
7380 Then one can run :
7381
7382 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7383
7384 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7385
7386 1
7387 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7388 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7389 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7390
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007391 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007392
7393 global
7394 stats socket /tmp/socket
7395 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7396
7397 defaults
7398 load-server-state-from-file local
7399
7400 backend bk
7401 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7402 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7403
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007404
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007405 Then one can run :
7406
7407 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7408
7409 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7410
7411 1
7412 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7413 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7414 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7415
7416 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7417 "show servers state"
7418
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007419
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007420log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007421log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007422 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007423no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007424 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7426 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007427
7428 Prefix :
7429 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7430 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7431 prefix does not allow arguments.
7432
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007433 Arguments :
7434 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7435 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7436 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7437 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7438 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7439 parameter.
7440
7441 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7442 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7443
7444 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7445 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7446 standard syslog port).
7447
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007448 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7449 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7450 standard syslog port).
7451
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007452 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7453 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7454 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007455 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007456
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007457 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7458 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7459 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7460 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7461 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7462 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7463 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7464 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7465 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7466 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7467 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7468 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7469 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7470 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7471 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7472 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007473 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7474 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007475
7476 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7477 and "fd@2", see above.
7478
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007479 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7480 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7481 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7482 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7483 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7484 having the logs instantly available.
7485
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007486 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7487 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7488 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7489
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007490 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7491 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007492
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007493 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7494 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7495 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7496 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7497 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7498 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7499 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7500 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7501 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7502 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007503 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007504
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007505 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7506 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7507 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7508 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7509 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7510
7511 <sample_size>
7512 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7513 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7514 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7515 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7516 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7517
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007518 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7519 one of the following :
7520
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007521 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7522 field is stripped. This is the default.
7523 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7524 rfc3164.
7525
7526 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007527 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7528
7529 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7530 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7531
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007532 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7533 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7534 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7535 designed to be used with a local log server.
7536
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007537 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7538 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7539 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7540 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7541 systemd logger consumes.
7542
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007543 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7544 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7545 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7546 used with a local log server.
7547
7548 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7549 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7550 designed to be used with a local log server.
7551
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007552 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7553 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7554 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7555 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7556
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007557 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7558
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007559 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7560 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7561 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7562
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007563 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7564 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7565 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7566 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007567
7568 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7569 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7570 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007571 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7572 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7573 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7574 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7575 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007576
7577 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7578
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007579 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7580 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7581 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007582
7583 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7584 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7585 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7586 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7587
7588 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7589 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007590
7591 Example :
7592 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007593 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7594 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7595 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007596 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007597 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7598 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007599 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007600
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007601
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007602log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007603 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7604 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7605 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007606
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007607 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7608 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7609 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7610 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7611 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007612
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007613 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7614 "option httplog" directives.
7615
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007616log-format-sd <string>
7617 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7618 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7619 yes | yes | yes | no
7620
7621 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7622 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7623 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7624 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7625 which covers the log format string in depth.
7626
7627 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7628 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7629
7630 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7631 log format to "rfc5424".
7632
7633 Example :
7634 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7635
7636
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007637log-tag <string>
7638 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7640 yes | yes | yes | yes
7641
7642 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7643 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7644 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7645 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7646 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7647 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7648 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7649 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7650 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007651
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007652max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7653 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7655 yes | no | yes | yes
7656
7657 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7658 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7659 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7660 servers.
7661
7662 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7663 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7664 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7665 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7666 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007667 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007668 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7669 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7670 picking a different server.
7671
7672 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7673 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7674 even if they have to be queued.
7675
7676 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7677 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7678
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007679max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7680 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7681 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7682 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007683
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007684maxconn <conns>
7685 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7687 yes | yes | yes | no
7688 Arguments :
7689 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7690 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7691 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7692 closes.
7693
7694 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7695 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7696 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7697 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007698 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7699 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7700 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7701 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007702
7703 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7704 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7705 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7706
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007707 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7708 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007709
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007710 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7711
7712
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007713mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007714 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7716 yes | yes | yes | yes
7717 Arguments :
7718 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7719 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7720 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7721 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7722
7723 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7724 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7725 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7726 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7727 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7728
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007729 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7730 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7731 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007732
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007733 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007734 defaults http_instances
7735 mode http
7736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007737
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007738monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007739 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7741 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007742 Arguments :
7743 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7744 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007745 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007746 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7747 backend and its backup.
7748
7749 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7750 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7751 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7752 servers in a list of backends.
7753
7754 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7755 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7756 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7757 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7758 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7759 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7760 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007761 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7762 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007763
7764 Example:
7765 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007766 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007767 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7768 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7769 monitor-uri /site_alive
7770 monitor fail if site_dead
7771
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007772 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007773
7774
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007775monitor-uri <uri>
7776 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7778 yes | yes | yes | no
7779 Arguments :
7780 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7781 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7782
7783 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7784 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7785 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7786 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7787 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7788 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7789 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7790 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7791
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007792 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007793 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7794 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7795 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7796 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7797 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7798 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007799
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007800 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7801 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7802 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7803 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7804
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007805 Example :
7806 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7807 frontend www
7808 mode http
7809 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7810
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007811 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007813
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007814option abortonclose
7815no option abortonclose
7816 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7818 yes | no | yes | yes
7819 Arguments : none
7820
7821 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7822 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7823 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7824 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007825 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007826 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7827 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7828 encountered while delivering the response.
7829
7830 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7831 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7832 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7833 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7834 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7835 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007836 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007837 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007838 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007839 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7840 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7841 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7842
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007843 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7844 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007845 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7846 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7847 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7848 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7849 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7850 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007851 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007852
7853 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7854 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7855
7856 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7857
7858
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007859option accept-invalid-http-request
7860no option accept-invalid-http-request
7861 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7863 yes | yes | yes | no
7864 Arguments : none
7865
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007866 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007867 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007868 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007869 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7870 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7871 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7872 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7873 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007874 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7875 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7876 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7877 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007878 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007879 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007880 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7881 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7882 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007883
7884 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7885 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7886 been confirmed.
7887
7888 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7889 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007890 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7891 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007892 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7893
7894 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7895 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7896
7897 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7898 stats socket.
7899
7900
7901option accept-invalid-http-response
7902no option accept-invalid-http-response
7903 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7905 yes | no | yes | yes
7906 Arguments : none
7907
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007908 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007909 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007910 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007911 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7912 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7913 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7914 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7915 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007916 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7917 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7918 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007919
7920 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7921 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7922 been confirmed.
7923
7924 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7925 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7926 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7927 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7928
7929 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7930 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7931
7932 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7933 stats socket.
7934
7935
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007936option allbackups
7937no option allbackups
7938 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7940 yes | no | yes | yes
7941 Arguments : none
7942
7943 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7944 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7945 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7946 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7947 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7948 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7949 order between the backup servers anymore.
7950
7951 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7952 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7953
7954 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7955 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7956
7957
7958option checkcache
7959no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007960 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 yes | no | yes | yes
7963 Arguments : none
7964
7965 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7966 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007967 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007968 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7969 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007970 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007971
7972 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007973 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007974 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007975 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7976 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007977 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007978 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007979 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7980 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007981 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007982 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7983 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007984 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007985 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7986 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7987 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7988 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7989 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7990 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7991 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7992 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7993 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7994
7995 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007996 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7997 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7998 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7999 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008000
8001 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8002 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008003 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008004 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008005
8006 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8007 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8008
8009
8010option clitcpka
8011no option clitcpka
8012 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8014 yes | yes | yes | no
8015 Arguments : none
8016
8017 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8018 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008019 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008020 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8021
8022 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8023 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8024 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8025 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8026
8027 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8028 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8029 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8030 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8031 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8032
8033 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8034
8035 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8036 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8037 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8038
8039 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8040 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8041
8042 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8043
8044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008045option contstats
8046 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8048 yes | yes | yes | no
8049 Arguments : none
8050
8051 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8052 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8053 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8054 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008055 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8056 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8057 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8058 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8059 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008060
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008061option disable-h2-upgrade
8062no option disable-h2-upgrade
8063 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8064 connection.
8065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8066 yes | yes | yes | no
8067 Arguments : none
8068
8069 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8070 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8071 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8072 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008073 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8074 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8075 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8076 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8077 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8078 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008079
8080 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8081 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008082
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008083option dontlog-normal
8084no option dontlog-normal
8085 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8087 yes | yes | yes | no
8088 Arguments : none
8089
8090 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8091 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8092 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8093 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8094 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8095 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8096 logged.
8097
8098 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8099 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8100 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008102 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008103 logging.
8104
8105
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008106option dontlognull
8107no option dontlognull
8108 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8110 yes | yes | yes | no
8111 Arguments : none
8112
8113 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8114 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8115 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8116 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8117 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8118 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008119 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8120 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8121 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008122
8123 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008124 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008125 would not be logged.
8126
8127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8129
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008130 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008131 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008132
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008133
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008134option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008135 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8137 yes | yes | yes | yes
8138 Arguments :
8139 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8140 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008141 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008142 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008143
8144 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8145 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8146 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8147 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8148 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8149 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8150 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008151 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8152 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8153 possible that the client has already brought one.
8154
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008155 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008156 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008157 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008158 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008159 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008160 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008161
8162 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8163 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8164 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8165 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8166 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8167 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008168 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008169
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008170 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8171 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8172 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8173 are under the control of the end-user.
8174
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008175 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008176 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8177 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008178 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8179 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8180 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008181
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008182 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008183 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8184 frontend www
8185 mode http
8186 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8187
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008188 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8189 backend www
8190 mode http
8191 option forwardfor header X-Client
8192
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008193 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008194 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008195
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008196
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008197option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8198no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8199 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8201 yes | yes | yes | no
8202 Arguments : none
8203
8204 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8205 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8206 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8207 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8208 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8209 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8210 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8211
8212 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8213 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8214 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8215 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8216 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8217 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8218 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8219 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8220 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8221 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8222
8223 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8224
8225 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8226 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8227
8228 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8229 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8230
8231
8232option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8233no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8234 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8236 yes | no | yes | yes
8237 Arguments : none
8238
8239 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8240 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8241 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8242 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8243 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8244 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8245 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8246
8247 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8248 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8249 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8250 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8251 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8252 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8253 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8254 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8255 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8256 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8257
8258 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8259
8260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8262
8263 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8264 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8265
8266
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008267option http-buffer-request
8268no option http-buffer-request
8269 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8271 yes | yes | yes | yes
8272 Arguments : none
8273
8274 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8275 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8276 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8277 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8278 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8279 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008280 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8281 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8282 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8283 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008284
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008285 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8286 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008287
8288
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008289option http-ignore-probes
8290no option http-ignore-probes
8291 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8293 yes | yes | yes | no
8294 Arguments : none
8295
8296 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8297 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8298 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8299 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8300 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8301 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8302 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8303 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8304 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008305 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8306 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008307 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8308
8309 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8310 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8311 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8312 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8313 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8314 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8315 are often the only way to detect them.
8316
8317 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8318 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8319
8320 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8321
8322
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008323option http-keep-alive
8324no option http-keep-alive
8325 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8327 yes | yes | yes | yes
8328 Arguments : none
8329
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008330 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8331 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008332 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8333 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008334 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8335 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8336 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008337
8338 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8339 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008340 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8341 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8342 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8343 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8344 situations where this option may be useful :
8345
8346 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008347 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008348
8349 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8350 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8351
8352 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8353 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8354 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8355 request.
8356
8357 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8358 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008359 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8360 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8361 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008362
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008363 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8364 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8365 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8366 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8367 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8368 not set.
8369
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008370 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8371 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8372 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008373
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008374 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008375 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008376 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008377
8378
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008379option http-no-delay
8380no option http-no-delay
8381 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8383 yes | yes | yes | yes
8384 Arguments : none
8385
8386 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8387 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8388 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8389 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8390 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8391 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8392 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8393 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8394 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8395 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8396 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8397 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8398 affected.
8399
8400 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8401 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8402 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8403 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8404 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8405 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8406 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8407 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8408 latency environments.
8409
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008410 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8411
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008412
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008413option http-pretend-keepalive
8414no option http-pretend-keepalive
8415 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008417 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008418 Arguments : none
8419
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008420 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008421 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8422 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8423 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8424 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8425 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8426 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8427 consider the response complete.
8428
8429 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8430 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8431 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8432 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008433 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008434 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8435
8436 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8437 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8438 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8439 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8440 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8441 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8442 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8443
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008444 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8445 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8446 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8447 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8448 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8449 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008450
8451 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8452 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8453
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008454 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008455 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008456
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008457
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008458option http-server-close
8459no option http-server-close
8460 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8462 yes | yes | yes | yes
8463 Arguments : none
8464
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008465 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8466 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8467 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8468 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008469 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8470 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8471 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8472 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8473 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8474 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8475 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8476 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8477 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8478 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8479 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008480
8481 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8482 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8483 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8484 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008485 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8486 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008487
8488 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8489 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008490 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8491 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8492 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008493
8494 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8495 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8496
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008497 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8498 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008499
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008500option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008501no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008502 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8504 yes | yes | yes | no
8505 Arguments : none
8506
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008507 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008508 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8509 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8510 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8511 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8512 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8513 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8514
8515 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8516 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008517 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8518 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8519 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008520
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008521 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8522 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8523 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8524 front of an existing proxy.
8525
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008526 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8527
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008528 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008529
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008530option httpchk
8531option httpchk <uri>
8532option httpchk <method> <uri>
8533option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008534 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8536 yes | no | yes | yes
8537 Arguments :
8538 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8539 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8540 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8541 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8542 ones.
8543
8544 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8545 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8546 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8547
8548 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8549 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8550 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008551 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008552
8553 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8554 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8555 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8556 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8557 the lack of any response.
8558
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008559 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8560 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8561 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8562 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8563
8564 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8565 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8566 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008567
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008568 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8569 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008570 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008571 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008572 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008573
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008574 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8575 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8576 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8577 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8578
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008579 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008580 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8581 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8582 backend https_relay
8583 mode tcp
8584 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8585 http-check send hdr Host www
8586 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008587
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008588 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8589 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8590 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008591
8592
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008593option httpclose
8594no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008595 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8597 yes | yes | yes | yes
8598 Arguments : none
8599
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008600 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8601 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8602 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8603 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008604 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008605
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008606 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8607 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008608 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008609 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8610 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008611
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008612 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8613 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8614 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008615
8616 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8617 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008618 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8619 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8620 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008621
8622 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8623 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8624
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008625 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008626
8627
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008628option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008629 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008631 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008632 Arguments :
8633 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8634 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8635 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008636 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008637 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008638
8639 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8640 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8641 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8642 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8643 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8644 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8645 ports.
8646
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008647 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8648 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008649
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008650 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008652 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008653
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008654
8655option http_proxy
8656no option http_proxy
8657 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8659 yes | yes | yes | yes
8660 Arguments : none
8661
8662 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8663 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8664 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8665 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8666 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8667
8668 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8669 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008670 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8671 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008672
8673 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8674 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8675
8676 Example :
8677 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8678 backend direct_forward
8679 option httpclose
8680 option http_proxy
8681
8682 See also : "option httpclose"
8683
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008684
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008685option independent-streams
8686no option independent-streams
8687 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8689 yes | yes | yes | yes
8690 Arguments : none
8691
8692 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8693 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8694 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8695 receive data or not.
8696
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008697 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008698 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8699 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8700 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8701 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8702 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8703 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8704 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8705 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8706 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8707 socket buffers.
8708
8709 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8710 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8711 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8712 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8713 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8714
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008715 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008716
8717
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008718option ldap-check
8719 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8721 yes | no | yes | yes
8722 Arguments : none
8723
8724 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8725 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8726 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8727 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8728
8729 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8730 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8731
8732 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8733 configure it.
8734
8735 Example :
8736 option ldap-check
8737
8738 See also : "option httpchk"
8739
8740
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008741option external-check
8742 Use external processes for server health checks
8743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8744 yes | no | yes | yes
8745
8746 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8747 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8748 command".
8749
8750 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8751
8752 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8753
8754
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008755option log-health-checks
8756no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008757 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8759 yes | no | yes | yes
8760 Arguments : none
8761
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008762 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8763 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8764 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008765
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008766 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8767 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8768 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8769 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8770 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8771
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008772 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008773 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008774
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008775 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8776 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8777 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008778
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008779
8780option log-separate-errors
8781no option log-separate-errors
8782 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8784 yes | yes | yes | no
8785 Arguments : none
8786
8787 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8788 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8789 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8790 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8791 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8792 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8793 provides very important information.
8794
8795 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8796 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8797 error logs.
8798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008799 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008800 logging.
8801
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008802
8803option logasap
8804no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008805 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8807 yes | yes | yes | no
8808 Arguments : none
8809
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008810 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8811 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8812 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8813 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8814
8815 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8816 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8817 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8818 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8819 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008820 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008821 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8822 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8823 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8824 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008825 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008826
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008827 Examples :
8828 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8829 mode http
8830 option httplog
8831 option logasap
8832 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8833
8834 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8835 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8836 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8837 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008839 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008840 logging.
8841
8842
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008843option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008844 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8846 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008847 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008848 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8849 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008850 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8851 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008852
8853 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8854 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008855 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008856 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8857 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8858 in the MySQL table, like this :
8859
8860 USE mysql;
8861 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8862 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8863
8864 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008865 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008866 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8867 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8868 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8869 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8870 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8871 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8872 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8873
8874 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8875 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008876
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008877 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008878
8879 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8880 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8881 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8882 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008883 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8884 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008885
8886 See also: "option httpchk"
8887
8888
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008889option nolinger
8890no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008891 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008892 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8893 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008894 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008895
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008896 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008897 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8898 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8899 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8900 connections.
8901
8902 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8903 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008904 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8905 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8906 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8907 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8908 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8909 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8910 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8911 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8912 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8913 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8914 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8915 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8916 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008917
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008918 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8919 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8920 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8921 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8922 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008923
8924 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8925 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008926 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008927 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008928 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008929
8930 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8931 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8932
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008933 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8934 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008935
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008936option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8937 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8939 yes | yes | yes | yes
8940 Arguments :
8941 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8942 matching <network>
8943 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8944 header name.
8945
8946 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8947 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8948 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8949 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8950 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8951 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8952 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8953 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8954 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8955 possible that the client has already brought one.
8956
8957 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8958 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8959 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8960 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8961 header and requires different one.
8962
8963 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8964 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8965 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01008966 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
8967 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
8968 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
8969 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
8970 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008971
8972 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8973 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8974 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8975 both are defined.
8976
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008977 Examples :
8978 # Original Destination address
8979 frontend www
8980 mode http
8981 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8982
8983 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8984 backend www
8985 mode http
8986 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8987
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008988 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008989
8990
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008991option persist
8992no option persist
8993 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8995 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008996 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008997
8998 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8999 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9000 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9001 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9002 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9003 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9004 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9005 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9006 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9007 redirected to another valid server.
9008
9009 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9010 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9011
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009012 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009013
9014
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009015option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9016 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9018 yes | no | yes | yes
9019 Arguments :
9020 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9021 PostgreSQL server.
9022
9023 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9024 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9025 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9026 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9027
9028 See also: "option httpchk"
9029
9030
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009031option prefer-last-server
9032no option prefer-last-server
9033 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9034 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9035 yes | no | yes | yes
9036 Arguments : none
9037
9038 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9039 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9040 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9041 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9042 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9043 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9044 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9045 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9046 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009047 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9048 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009049 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9050 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9051 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009052 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9053 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9054 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009055
9056 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9057 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9058
9059 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9060
9061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009062option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009063option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009064no option redispatch
9065 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9066 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9067 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009068 Arguments :
9069 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9070 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9071 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009072 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009073 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009074 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009075 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9076 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9077 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009079
9080 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9081 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9082 be able to access the service anymore.
9083
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009084 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9085 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009086
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009087 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9088 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9089 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9090 following order:
9091
9092 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9093
9094 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9095 list, or
9096
9097 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9098
9099 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9100 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9101
9102 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9103 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9104 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9105 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9106
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009107 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009108 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9109 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9113
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009114 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009115
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009116
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009117option redis-check
9118 Use redis health checks for server testing
9119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9120 yes | no | yes | yes
9121 Arguments : none
9122
9123 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9124 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9125 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9126 find the "+PONG" response message.
9127
9128 Example :
9129 option redis-check
9130
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009131 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009132
9133
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009134option smtpchk
9135option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9136 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9138 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009139 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009140 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009141 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009142 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9143
9144 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9145 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9146 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9147
9148 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9149 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9150 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9151 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9152 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9153 dead server.
9154
9155 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9156 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009157 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009158 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9159
9160 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9161 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9162 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9163 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009164 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009165
9166 Example :
9167 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9168
9169 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9170
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009172option socket-stats
9173no option socket-stats
9174
9175 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9177 yes | yes | yes | no
9178
9179 Arguments : none
9180
9181
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009182option splice-auto
9183no option splice-auto
9184 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9186 yes | yes | yes | yes
9187 Arguments : none
9188
9189 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9190 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009191 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009192 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009193 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009194 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9195 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9196 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9197 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9198
9199 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9200 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9201 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9202 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9203 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9204 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9205 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9206 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9207 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9208 keyword.
9209
9210 Example :
9211 option splice-auto
9212
9213 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9214 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9215
9216 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9217 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9218
9219
9220option splice-request
9221no option splice-request
9222 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9224 yes | yes | yes | yes
9225 Arguments : none
9226
9227 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009228 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009229 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9230 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9231 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9232 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9233
9234 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9235
9236 Example :
9237 option splice-request
9238
9239 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9240 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9241
9242 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9243 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9244
9245
9246option splice-response
9247no option splice-response
9248 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9250 yes | yes | yes | yes
9251 Arguments : none
9252
9253 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009254 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009255 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9256 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9257 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9258 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9259
9260 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9261
9262 Example :
9263 option splice-response
9264
9265 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9266 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9267
9268 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9269 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9270
9271
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009272option spop-check
9273 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9275 no | no | no | yes
9276 Arguments : none
9277
9278 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9279 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9280 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9281 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9282
9283 Example :
9284 option spop-check
9285
9286 See also : "option httpchk"
9287
9288
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009289option srvtcpka
9290no option srvtcpka
9291 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9293 yes | no | yes | yes
9294 Arguments : none
9295
9296 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9297 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009298 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009299 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9300
9301 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9302 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9303 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9304 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9305
9306 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9307 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9308 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9309 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9310 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9311
9312 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9313
9314 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9315 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9316 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9317
9318 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9319 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9320
9321 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9322
9323
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009324option ssl-hello-chk
9325 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9327 yes | no | yes | yes
9328 Arguments : none
9329
9330 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9331 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9332 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9333 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9334 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9335 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9336 hello message.
9337
9338 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9339 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9340 messages, which is appreciable.
9341
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009342 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9343 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9344 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009345
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009346 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9347
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009348
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009349option tcp-check
9350 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9351 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9352 yes | no | yes | yes
9353
9354 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9355 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9356
9357 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9358 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9359 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9360
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009361 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009362 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9363 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9364 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9365 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9366 only.
9367
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009368 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009369 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9370 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9371 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9372 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9373
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009374 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009375 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9376 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009377 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009378 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9379 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9380 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9381 the respective protocols.
9382 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009383 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009384
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009385 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009386
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009387 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9388 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9389 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9390 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009391
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009392 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9393 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9394 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009395
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009396
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009397 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009398 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009399 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009400 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009401
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009402 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009403 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009404 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009405
9406 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9407 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009408 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009409 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009410 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009411 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009412 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009413 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009414 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9415 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009416 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009417 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9418 tcp-check expect string +OK
9419
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009420 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009421 (send many headers before analyzing)
9422 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009423 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009424 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9425 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9426 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9427 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009428 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009429
9430
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009431 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009432
9433
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009434option tcp-smart-accept
9435no option tcp-smart-accept
9436 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9438 yes | yes | yes | no
9439 Arguments : none
9440
9441 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9442 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9443 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9444 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9445 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9446 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9447
9448 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9449 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9450 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9451 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9452
9453 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9454 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9455 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009456 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009457
9458 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9459 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9460 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9461
9462 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9463 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9464 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9465
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009466 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9467
9468
9469option tcp-smart-connect
9470no option tcp-smart-connect
9471 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9473 yes | no | yes | yes
9474 Arguments : none
9475
9476 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9477 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9478 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9479 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9480 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9481
9482 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9483 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9484 complex.
9485
9486 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9487 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9488 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9489
9490 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9491 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9492
9493 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9494
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009495
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009496option tcpka
9497 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9499 yes | yes | yes | yes
9500 Arguments : none
9501
9502 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9503 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009504 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009505 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9506
9507 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9508 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9509 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9510 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9511
9512 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9513 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9514 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9515 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9516 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9517
9518 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9519
9520 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9521 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9522 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9523 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9524 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9525 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9526 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9527 backends.
9528
9529 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9530
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009531
9532option tcplog
9533 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009535 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009536 Arguments : none
9537
9538 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9539 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9540 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9541 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9542 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9543 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9544 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9545 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9546
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009547 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009549 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009550
9551
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009552option transparent
9553no option transparent
9554 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009556 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009557 Arguments : none
9558
9559 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9560 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9561 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9562 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9563 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9564 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9565 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9566 appropriate server.
9567
9568 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9569 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9570
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009571 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009572 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009573
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009574
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009575external-check command <command>
9576 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9578 yes | no | yes | yes
9579
9580 Arguments :
9581 <command> is the external command to run
9582
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009583 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9584
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009585 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009586
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009587 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9588 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9589 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9590 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9591 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9592 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009593
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009594 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9595
9596 Environment variables :
9597 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9598 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9599
9600 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9601
9602 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9603
9604 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9605 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9606 for a UNIX socket).
9607
9608 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9609
9610 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9611
9612 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9613
9614 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9615
9616 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9617
9618 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9619 socket).
9620
9621 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9622 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9623
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009624 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9625
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009626 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9627 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9628 failed.
9629
9630 Example :
9631 external-check command /bin/true
9632
9633 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9634
9635
9636external-check path <path>
9637 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9639 yes | no | yes | yes
9640
9641 Arguments :
9642 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9643
9644 The default path is "".
9645
9646 Example :
9647 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9648
9649 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9650 "external-check command"
9651
9652
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009653persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009654persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009655 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9657 yes | no | yes | yes
9658 Arguments :
9659 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009660 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9661 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009662
9663 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9664 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009665 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009666 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9667 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9668 forwarded to this server.
9669
9670 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9671 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9672 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009673 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009674 a single "listen" section.
9675
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009676 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9677 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9678 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9679
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009680 Example :
9681 listen tse-farm
9682 bind :3389
9683 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9684 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9685 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9686 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9687 persist rdp-cookie
9688 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009689 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009690 balance rdp-cookie
9691 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9692 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9693
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009694 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9695 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009696
9697
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009698rate-limit sessions <rate>
9699 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9701 yes | yes | yes | no
9702 Arguments :
9703 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9704 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9705
9706 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9707 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9708 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9709 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9710 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9711 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9712
9713 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9714 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9715 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9716 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9717
9718 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9719 listen smtp
9720 mode tcp
9721 bind :25
9722 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009723 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009724
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009725 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9726 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9727 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009728
9729 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9730
9731
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009732redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9733redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9734redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009735 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9737 no | yes | yes | yes
9738
9739 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009740 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009741
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009742 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009743 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009744 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9745 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9746 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009747
9748 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9749 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9750 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9751 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9752 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009753 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9754 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9755 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9756 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009757
9758 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9759 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9760 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9761 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9762 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9763 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009764 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009765 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009766 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9767 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9768 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009769
9770 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009771 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9772 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9773 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009774 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009775 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9776 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9777 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9778 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009779
9780 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009781 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009782
9783 - "drop-query"
9784 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9785 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9786 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9787 with a location-type redirect.
9788
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009789 - "append-slash"
9790 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9791 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9792 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9793 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9794
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009795 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9796 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9797 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9798 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9799 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9800 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9801 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9802
9803 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9804 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9805 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9806 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9807 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9808 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9809 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009810
9811 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9812 acl clear dst_port 80
9813 acl secure dst_port 8080
9814 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009815 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009816 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009817 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9818
9819 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009820 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9821 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9822 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009823 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009824
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009825 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9826 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9827 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9828
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009829 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009830 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009831
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009832 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009833 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9834 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9835 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009837 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009838
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009839
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009840retries <value>
9841 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9843 yes | no | yes | yes
9844 Arguments :
9845 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9846 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9847 default value is 3.
9848
9849 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9850 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9851 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9852
9853 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009854 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9855 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009856
9857 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9858 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9859
9860 See also : "option redispatch"
9861
9862
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009863retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009864 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9865 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9866 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9868 yes | no | yes | yes
9869 Arguments :
9870 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9871 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9872 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9873 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9874
9875 none never retry
9876
9877 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9878 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9879
9880 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9881 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9882 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9883 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9884 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9885 processing the request.
9886
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009887 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9888 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9889 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9890 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9891 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9892 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9893 overflow attack for example).
9894
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009895 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9896 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9897 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9898 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9899 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9900 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9901 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9902 amplify denial of service attacks.
9903
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009904 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9905 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9906 considered to be safe to retry.
9907
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009908 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9909 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9910 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9911 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9912 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009913
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009914 all-retryable-errors
9915 retry request for any error that are considered
9916 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9917 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9918 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9919
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009920 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9921 not cumulative.
9922
9923 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9924 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9925 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9926 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9927
9928 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9929 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9930 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9931 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9932 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9933 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9934 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9935 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9936 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9937 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9938 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9939 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9940
9941 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9942 should not use this directive.
9943
9944 The default is "conn-failure".
9945
9946 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9947
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009948server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009949 Declare a server in a backend
9950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9951 no | no | yes | yes
9952 Arguments :
9953 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009954 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009955 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009956
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009957 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9958 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9959 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9960 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009961 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9962 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9963 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9964 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9965 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009966 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9967 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9968 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9969 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9970 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9971 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9972 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009973 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009974 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9975 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9976 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9977 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9978 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9979 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009980 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9981 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009982 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9983 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009984
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009985 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009986 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9987 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9988 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9989 adding this value to the client's port.
9990
9991 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9992 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009993 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009994
9995 Examples :
9996 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9997 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009998 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009999 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10000 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10001 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010002
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010003 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10004 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10005 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10006 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10007 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10008
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010009 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10010 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010011
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010012server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010013 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010014 this backend.
10015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10016 no | no | yes | yes
10017
10018 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10019 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10020 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10021 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10022 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010023
10024 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10025 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10026
10027 global
10028 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10029
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010030 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010031 load-server-state-from-file
10032
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010033 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010034 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010035
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010036server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10037 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10038 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10040 no | no | yes | yes
10041
10042 Arguments:
10043 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10044
10045 <num | range>
10046 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10047 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10048 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10049 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10050
10051 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10052
10053 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10054
10055 <params*>
10056 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10057 keyword.
10058
10059 Examples:
10060 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10061 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10062 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10063
10064 # or
10065 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10066
10067 # would be equivalent to:
10068 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10069 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10070 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10071
10072
10073
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010074source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010075source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010076source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010077 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10079 yes | no | yes | yes
10080 Arguments :
10081 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10082 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010083
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010084 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010085 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10086 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10087 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10088 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10089 supported prefixes are :
10090 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10091 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10092 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010093 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010094 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10095 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010096
10097 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10098 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010099 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10100 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10101 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010102
10103 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10104 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10105 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10106 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10107 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10108 <addr>.
10109
10110 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10111 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10112 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10113 port.
10114
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010115 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10116 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10117 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10118 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010119 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010120 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10121 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10122 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10123 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10124 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10125 HTTP header.
10126
10127 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10128 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010129 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010130 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10131 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10132 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10133 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10134 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10135 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10136 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10137
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010138 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10139 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10140 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10141 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10142 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10143 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10144
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010145 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10146 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10147 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10148 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10149
10150 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10151 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10152 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10153 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10154 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10155 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10156
10157 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10158 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10159 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10160 there are two methods :
10161
10162 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10163 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10164 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10165 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10166 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10167 of the client ranges may be used.
10168
10169 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10170 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10171 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10172 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10173 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10174 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10175 same session.
10176
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010177 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10178 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10179 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010180 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010181
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010182 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10183
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010184 Examples :
10185 backend private
10186 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10187 source 192.168.1.200
10188
10189 backend transparent_ssl1
10190 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10191 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10192
10193 backend transparent_ssl2
10194 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10195 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10196 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10197
10198 backend transparent_ssl3
10199 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10200 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10201 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10202
10203 backend transparent_smtp
10204 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10205 # with Tproxy version 4.
10206 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10207
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010208 backend transparent_http
10209 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10210 # proxy.
10211 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010213 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010214 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10215
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010216
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010217srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10218 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10219 the connection on the server side.
10220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10221 yes | no | yes | yes
10222 Arguments :
10223 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10224
10225 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10226 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010227 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10228 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010229
10230 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10231
10232
10233srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10234 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10235 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10236 server side.
10237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10238 yes | no | yes | yes
10239 Arguments :
10240 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10241 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10242 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10243 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10244
10245 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10246 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010247 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10248 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010249
10250 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10251
10252
10253srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10254 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10256 yes | no | yes | yes
10257 Arguments :
10258 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10259 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10260 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10261 document.
10262
10263 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10264 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010265 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10266 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010267
10268 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10269
10270
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010271stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10272 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010274 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010275
10276 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10277 matched.
10278
10279 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10280 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10281
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010282 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10283 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010284 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010285
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010286 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10287 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10288 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10289 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010290
10291 Example :
10292 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10293 backend stats_localhost
10294 stats enable
10295 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10296
10297 Example :
10298 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10299 backend stats_auth
10300 stats enable
10301 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10302 stats admin if TRUE
10303
10304 Example :
10305 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10306 userlist stats-auth
10307 group admin users admin
10308 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10309 group readonly users haproxy
10310 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10311
10312 backend stats_auth
10313 stats enable
10314 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10315 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10316 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10317 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10318
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010319 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10320 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10321 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010322
10323
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010324stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10325 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010327 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010328 Arguments :
10329 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10330
10331 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10332
10333 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10334 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10335 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10336 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10337 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10338 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10339
10340 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10341 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10342 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010343 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010344
10345 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10346 report using "stats scope".
10347
10348 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10349 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10350 unobvious parameters.
10351
10352 Example :
10353 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10354 backend public_www
10355 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10356 stats enable
10357 stats hide-version
10358 stats scope .
10359 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010360 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010361 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10362 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10363
10364 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10365 backend private_monitoring
10366 stats enable
10367 stats uri /admin?stats
10368 stats refresh 5s
10369
10370 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10371
10372
10373stats enable
10374 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010376 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010377 Arguments : none
10378
10379 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10380 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10381 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10382 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10383 - stats auth : no authentication
10384 - stats scope : no restriction
10385
10386 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10387 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10388 unobvious parameters.
10389
10390 Example :
10391 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10392 backend public_www
10393 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10394 stats enable
10395 stats hide-version
10396 stats scope .
10397 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010398 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010399 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10400 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10401
10402 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10403 backend private_monitoring
10404 stats enable
10405 stats uri /admin?stats
10406 stats refresh 5s
10407
10408 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10409
10410
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010411stats hide-version
10412 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010414 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010415 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010416
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010417 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10418 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10419 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10420 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10421 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10422 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010424 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10425 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10426 unobvious parameters.
10427
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010428 Example :
10429 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10430 backend public_www
10431 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010432 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010433 stats hide-version
10434 stats scope .
10435 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010436 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010437 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10438 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010439
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010440 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10441 backend private_monitoring
10442 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010443 stats uri /admin?stats
10444 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010445
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010446 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010447
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010448
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010449stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10450 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10451 Access control for statistics
10452
10453 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10454 no | no | yes | yes
10455
10456 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10457 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10458 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10459 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10460 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10461 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10462
10463 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10464 instance.
10465
10466 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10467 about ACL usage.
10468
10469
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010470stats realm <realm>
10471 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010473 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010474 Arguments :
10475 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10476 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10477 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10478
10479 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10480 using a backslash ('\').
10481
10482 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10483 only related to authentication.
10484
10485 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10486 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10487 unobvious parameters.
10488
10489 Example :
10490 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10491 backend public_www
10492 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10493 stats enable
10494 stats hide-version
10495 stats scope .
10496 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010497 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010498 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10499 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10500
10501 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10502 backend private_monitoring
10503 stats enable
10504 stats uri /admin?stats
10505 stats refresh 5s
10506
10507 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10508
10509
10510stats refresh <delay>
10511 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010513 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010514 Arguments :
10515 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10516 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10517 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10518 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10519 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10520 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10521
10522 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10523 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10524 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010525 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010526
10527 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10528 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10529 unobvious parameters.
10530
10531 Example :
10532 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10533 backend public_www
10534 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10535 stats enable
10536 stats hide-version
10537 stats scope .
10538 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010539 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010540 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10541 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10542
10543 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10544 backend private_monitoring
10545 stats enable
10546 stats uri /admin?stats
10547 stats refresh 5s
10548
10549 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10550
10551
10552stats scope { <name> | "." }
10553 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010555 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010556 Arguments :
10557 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10558 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10559 section in which the statement appears.
10560
10561 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10562 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10563 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10564 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10565 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10566 exists.
10567
10568 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10569 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10570 unobvious parameters.
10571
10572 Example :
10573 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10574 backend public_www
10575 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10576 stats enable
10577 stats hide-version
10578 stats scope .
10579 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010580 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010581 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10582 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10583
10584 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10585 backend private_monitoring
10586 stats enable
10587 stats uri /admin?stats
10588 stats refresh 5s
10589
10590 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10591
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010592
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010593stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010594 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010596 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010597
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010598 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010599 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10600
10601 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10602 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10603
10604 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10605 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010606 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010607
10608 Example :
10609 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10610 backend private_monitoring
10611 stats enable
10612 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10613 stats uri /admin?stats
10614 stats refresh 5s
10615
10616 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10617 global section.
10618
10619
10620stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010621 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10623 yes | yes | yes | yes
10624 Arguments : none
10625
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010626 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010627 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10628 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10629 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10630 - IP (socket, server)
10631 - cookie (backend, server)
10632
10633 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10634 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010635 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010636
10637 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10638
10639
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010640stats show-modules
10641 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10643 yes | yes | yes | yes
10644 Arguments : none
10645
10646 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10647 values as a tooltip.
10648
10649 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10650 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10651 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10652
10653 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10654
10655
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010656stats show-node [ <name> ]
10657 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010659 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010660 Arguments:
10661 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10662 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10663
10664 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10665 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010666 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010667
10668 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10669 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10670 unobvious parameters.
10671
10672 Example:
10673 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10674 backend private_monitoring
10675 stats enable
10676 stats show-node Europe-1
10677 stats uri /admin?stats
10678 stats refresh 5s
10679
10680 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10681 section.
10682
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010683
10684stats uri <prefix>
10685 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010687 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010688 Arguments :
10689 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10690 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10691 query string.
10692
10693 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10694 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10695 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10696 possible to reach it in the application.
10697
10698 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010699 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010700 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10701 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10702 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10703 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10704
10705 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10706 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10707 an address or a port to statistics only.
10708
10709 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10710 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10711 unobvious parameters.
10712
10713 Example :
10714 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10715 backend public_www
10716 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10717 stats enable
10718 stats hide-version
10719 stats scope .
10720 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010721 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010722 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10723 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10724
10725 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10726 backend private_monitoring
10727 stats enable
10728 stats uri /admin?stats
10729 stats refresh 5s
10730
10731 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10732
10733
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010734stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10735 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010737 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010738
10739 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010740 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010741 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010742 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010743 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10744
10745 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10746 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10747 the "stick-table" statement.
10748
10749 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10750 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10751 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10752 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10753 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10754
10755 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10756 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10757 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10758 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10759 transformation rules.
10760
10761 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10762 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10763 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10764 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10765 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10766 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10767 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10768
10769 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10770 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10771 ACL based conditions.
10772
10773 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10774 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10775 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10776 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10777
10778 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10779 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10780 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10781 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10782
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010783 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10784 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010785 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010786
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010787 Example :
10788 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10789 # last 30 minutes
10790 backend pop
10791 mode tcp
10792 balance roundrobin
10793 stick store-request src
10794 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10795 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10796 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10797
10798 backend smtp
10799 mode tcp
10800 balance roundrobin
10801 stick match src table pop
10802 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10803 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10804
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010805 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010806 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010807
10808
10809stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10810 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10812 no | no | yes | yes
10813
10814 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10815 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10816 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10817 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10818
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010819 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10820 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010821 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010822
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010823 Examples :
10824 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010825 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010826
10827 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10828 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10829 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10830
10831
10832 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10833 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10834 backend http
10835 mode http
10836 balance roundrobin
10837 stick on src table https
10838 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10839 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10840 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10841
10842 backend https
10843 mode tcp
10844 balance roundrobin
10845 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10846 stick on src
10847 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10848 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10849
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010850 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010851
10852
10853stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10854 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10856 no | no | yes | yes
10857
10858 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010859 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010860 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010861 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010862 server is selected.
10863
10864 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10865 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10866 the "stick-table" statement.
10867
10868 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10869 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10870 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10871 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10872 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10873 address.
10874
10875 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10876 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10877 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10878 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10879 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10880 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10881 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10882 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10883 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10884 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10885
10886 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10887 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10888 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10889 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10890 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10891 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10892 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10893
10894 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10895 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10896 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10897 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10898
10899 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10900 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10901 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10902 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10903 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10904 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010905 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10906 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10907 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10908 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10909 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10910 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010911
10912 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10913 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10914 the request.
10915
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010916 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10917 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010918 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010919
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010920 Example :
10921 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10922 # last 30 minutes
10923 backend pop
10924 mode tcp
10925 balance roundrobin
10926 stick store-request src
10927 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10928 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10929 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10930
10931 backend smtp
10932 mode tcp
10933 balance roundrobin
10934 stick match src table pop
10935 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10936 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10937
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010938 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010939 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010940
10941
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010942stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010943 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010944 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010945 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010947 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010948
10949 Arguments :
10950 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10951 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10952 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10953 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10954
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010955 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10956 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10957 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10958 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10959
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010960 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10961 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10962 instance.
10963
10964 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10965 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10966 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10967 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10968 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10969 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010970 to 32 characters.
10971
10972 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10973 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10974 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010975 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010976 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10977 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010978
10979 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010980 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10981 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010982 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10983 increase.
10984
10985 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010986 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10987 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10988 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010989
10990 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10991 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10992 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10993 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010994 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010995 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10996 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10997 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10998 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10999 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11000 parameter (see below).
11001
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011002 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11003 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11004 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11005 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11006 soft restart.
11007
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011008 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11009 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011010
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011011 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11012 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11013 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11014 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011015 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011016 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011017 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11018 if not expiration delay is specified.
11019
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011020 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11021 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11022 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11023 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11024 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11025 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11026 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11027 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11028 token.
11029
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011030 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11031 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11032 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11033 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011034 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11035 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11036 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11037 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11038 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11039 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11040 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11041 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11042 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11043 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11044 types and their arguments.
11045
11046 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11047 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11048 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11049 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11050
11051 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11052 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11053 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011054 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011055
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011056 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11057 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11058 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011059 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011060 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011061 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011062
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011063 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11064 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11065 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11066 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11067
11068 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11069 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11070 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11071 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11072 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11073 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11074
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011075 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11076 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11077 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11078 they were received.
11079
11080 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11081 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11082 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11083 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11084 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11085
11086 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11087 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11088 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11089 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11090 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11091
11092 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11093 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11094 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11095
11096 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11097 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11098 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11099 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11100 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11101
11102 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11103 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11104 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11105 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11106 the client side.
11107
11108 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11109 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11110 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11111 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11112 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11113 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11114 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11115
11116 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11117 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11118 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11119 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11120 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11121 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011122 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011123
11124 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11125 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11126 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11127 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11128 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11129 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11130
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011131 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11132 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11133 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11134 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11135 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11136
11137 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11138 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11139 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11140 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11141 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11142 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11143
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011144 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011145 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011146 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11147 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11148
11149 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11150 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11151 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11152 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11153 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11154 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11155 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11156 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11157 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11158 recommended for better fairness.
11159
11160 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011161 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011162 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11163 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11164
11165 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11166 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11167 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11168 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11169 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11170 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11171 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11172 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11173 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11174 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011175
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011176 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11177 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011178 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11179 reference it.
11180
11181 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11182 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011183 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11184 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11185 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011186
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011187 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11188 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11189 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11190 something that can be ignored.
11191
11192 Example:
11193 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11194 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11195 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11196 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11197
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011198 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011199 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011200
11201
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011202stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011203 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11205 no | no | yes | yes
11206
11207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011208 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011209 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011210 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011211 server is selected.
11212
11213 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11214 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11215 the "stick-table" statement.
11216
11217 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11218 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11219 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11220 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11221
11222 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11223 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11224 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11225 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11226 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11227 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011228 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011229 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11230 rules.
11231
11232 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11233 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11234 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11235 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11236 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11237 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11238 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11239
11240 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11241 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11242 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11243 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11244
11245 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11246 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11247 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11248 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11249 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11250 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011251 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11252 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11253 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11254 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11255 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11256 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11257 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11258 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11259 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011260
11261 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11262
11263 Example :
11264 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11265 backend https
11266 mode tcp
11267 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011268 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011269 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011270
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011271 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11272 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11273
11274 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11275 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11276 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11277
11278 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11279 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011280
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011281 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11282 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11283 # at offset 44.
11284
11285 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11286 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11287
11288 # Learn on response if server hello.
11289 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011290
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011291 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11292 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11293
11294 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11295 extraction.
11296
11297
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011298tcp-check comment <string>
11299 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11300 it fails.
11301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11302 yes | no | yes | yes
11303
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011304 Arguments :
11305 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11306 rule fails.
11307
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011308 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11309 user-friendly error reporting.
11310
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011311 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11312 "tcp-check expect".
11313
11314
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011315tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11316 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011317 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011318 Opens a new connection
11319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011320 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011321
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011322 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011323 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11324
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011325 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011326 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011327
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011328 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011329 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11330 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011331 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011332
11333 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011334
11335 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11336
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011337 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11338
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011339 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11340
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011341 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11342
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011343 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11344 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11345 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11346 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11347
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011348 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11349 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11350 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11351 haproxy -vv.
11352
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011353 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011354
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011355 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11356 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11357 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11358
11359 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11360 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11361 of the sequence.
11362
11363 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11364 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11365 do.
11366
11367 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11368 unset-var or comment rules.
11369
11370 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011371 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11372 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11373 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11374 option tcp-check
11375 tcp-check connect
11376 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11377 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11378 tcp-check send \r\n
11379 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11380 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11381 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11382 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11383 tcp-check send \r\n
11384 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11385 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11386
11387 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11388 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011389 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011390 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11391 tcp-check connect port 143
11392 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11393 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11394
11395 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11396
11397
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011398tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011399 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011400 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011401 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011402 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011404 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011405
11406 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011407 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11408
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011409 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11410 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11411 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11412 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11413 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11414 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11415 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11416 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11417 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11418 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11419
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011420 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011421 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11422 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011423 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11424 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11425 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11426
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011427 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11428 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11429 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011430 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11431 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011432 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11433 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011434 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11435 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011436 By default "L7OK" is used.
11437
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011438 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11439 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011440 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11441 supported :
11442 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11443 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011444 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11445 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11446 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11447 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11448 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011449
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011450 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011451 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011452 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11453 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11454 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11455 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011456 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11457
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011458 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11459 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11460 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11461 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11462
11463 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11464 informational message reported in logs if an error
11465 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11466 log-format string.
11467
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011468 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11469 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11470 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11471 followed by some converters.
11472
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011473 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11474 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11475 with the usual backslash ('\').
11476 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011477 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011478 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11479 used upper or lower case.
11480
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011481 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11482
11483 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11484 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11485 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11486 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11487 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11488 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11489 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11490 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11491
11492 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11493 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11494 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11495 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11496 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11497 expression.
11498
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011499 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11500 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11501 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11502 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11503 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11504 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11505
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011506 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11507 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11508 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11509 this exact hexadecimal string.
11510 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11511
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011512 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11513 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11514 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11515 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11516 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11517 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11518 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11519 size.
11520
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011521 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11522 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11523 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11524 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11525 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11526 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11527 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11528 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11529 in a binary string before matching the response's
11530 buffer.
11531
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011532 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011533 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011534 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11535 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11536 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11537 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11538 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11539 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11540 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11541 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11542 the null character.
11543
11544 Examples :
11545 # perform a POP check
11546 option tcp-check
11547 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11548
11549 # perform an IMAP check
11550 option tcp-check
11551 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11552
11553 # look for the redis master server
11554 option tcp-check
11555 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011556 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011557 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11558 tcp-check expect string role:master
11559 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11560 tcp-check expect string +OK
11561
11562
11563 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011564 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011565
11566
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011567tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11568tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11569 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11570 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011572 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011573
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011574 Arguments :
11575 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11576
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011577 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11578 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011579
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011580 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11581 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011582
11583 Examples :
11584 # look for the redis master server
11585 option tcp-check
11586 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11587 tcp-check expect string role:master
11588
11589 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011590 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011591
11592
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011593tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11594tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11595 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11596 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011598 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011599
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011600 Arguments :
11601 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011602
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011603 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11604 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011605
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011606 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11607 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11608 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011609
11610 Examples :
11611 # redis check in binary
11612 option tcp-check
11613 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11614 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11615
11616
11617 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011618 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011619
11620
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011621tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011622 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011623 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011624 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011625
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011626 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011627 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11628 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11629 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11630 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11631 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11632 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11633 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11634 and '-'.
11635
11636 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11637
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011638 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011639 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11640
11641
11642tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011643 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011644 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011645 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011646
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011647 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011648 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11649 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11650 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11651 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11652 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11653 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11654 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11655 and '-'.
11656
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011657 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011658 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11659
11660
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011661tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11662 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11664 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011665 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011666 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11667 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011668
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011669 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011670
11671 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11672 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011673 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11674 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11675 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11676 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11677 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11678 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011679
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011680 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11681 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11682 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11683 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011684
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011685 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011686 - accept :
11687 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11688 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11689 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011690
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011691 - reject :
11692 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11693 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11694 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11695 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11696 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11697 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11698 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11699 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11700 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11701 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11702 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011703 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011704
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011705 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11706 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11707 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11708 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11709 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11710 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11711 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11712 hosts.
11713
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011714 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11715 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11716 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11717 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11718 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11719 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11720 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11721 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11722
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011723 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11724 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11725 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11726 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11727 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11728 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11729 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11730 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11731 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011732 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11733 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011734
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011735 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011736 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011737 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11738 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11739 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011740 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011741 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011742 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11743 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11744 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11745 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11746 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11747 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11748 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011749
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011750 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011751 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011753 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011754 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11755 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11756 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011757
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011758 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11759 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11760 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11761 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011762
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011763 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11764 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11765 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11766 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11767 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011768 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11769 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11770 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11771 layer7 information is extracted.
11772
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011773 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11774 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11775 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11776 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11777 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011778
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011779 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11780 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11781 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11782 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11783
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011784 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11785 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11786 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11787 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11788
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011789 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11790 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11791 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11792 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11793 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011794
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011795 - set-src <expr> :
11796 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11797 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11798 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011799 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011800
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011801 Arguments:
11802 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11803 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011804
11805 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011806 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11807
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011808 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11809 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011810
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011811 - set-src-port <expr> :
11812 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11813 expression.
11814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011815 Arguments:
11816 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11817 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011818
11819 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011820 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11821
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011822 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11823 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11824 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011825
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011826 - set-dst <expr> :
11827 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11828 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11829 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11830 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11831 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11832
11833 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11834 followed by some converters.
11835
11836 Example:
11837
11838 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11839 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11840
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011841 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11842 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11843
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011844 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11845 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11846 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11847 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11848
11849
11850 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11851 followed by some converters.
11852
11853 Example:
11854
11855 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11856
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011857 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11858 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11859 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11860
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011861 - "silent-drop" :
11862 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011863 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011864 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11865 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11866 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11867 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11868 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011869 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11870 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011871 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11872 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011873 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011874 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11875 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11876 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11877 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11878
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011879 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11880 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11881 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011882
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011883 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11884 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11885 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011886
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011887 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011888 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011889 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011890
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011891 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11892 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11893 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011894
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011895 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011896 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11897 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011898
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011899 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11900
11901 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11902
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011903 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11904
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011905 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011906
11907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011908tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11909 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011911 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011913 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11914 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011916 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011917
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011918 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011919 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11920 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011921 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
11922 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011923
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011924 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11925 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11926 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11927 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011928 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11929 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11930 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11931 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11932 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11933 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011934 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011935 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011936
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011937 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11938 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11939 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11940 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011941
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011942 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011943 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011944 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011945 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11946 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011947 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011948 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011949 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011950 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011951 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011952 - set-dst <expr>
11953 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011954 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011955 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011956 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011957 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011958 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011959 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011960
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011961 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11962 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011963 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11964 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011965
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011966 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11967 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11968 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11969 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11970 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11971 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011973 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011974 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11975 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011976
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011977 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11978 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11979 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11980 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11981 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11982 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11983
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011984 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011985 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11986 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11987 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11988 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11989 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11990 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11991 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11992 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11993 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11994 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011995
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011996 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011997 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11998 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11999 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012000
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012001 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12002 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12003
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012004 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012005 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12006 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012007
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012008 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12009 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012010 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012011 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12012 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012013 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012014 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012015 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012016 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12017 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012018 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012019 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12020 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012021
12022 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12023 followed by some converters.
12024
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012025 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12026 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12027 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12028 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12029 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12030 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12031 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
12032 warning. These directives will be conditionnaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
12033 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12034 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12035
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012036 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12037
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012038 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12039 <var-name>.
12040
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012041 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12042 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12043 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12044 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12045 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12046
12047 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12048 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12049 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12050 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12051 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12052 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12053 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12054 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12055 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12056 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12057 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12058
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012059 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12060 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12061 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12062 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12063 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12064
12065 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12066
12067 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12068
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012069 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12070 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12071 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12072 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12073 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12074 evaluated.
12075
12076 Example:
12077 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12078
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012079 Example:
12080
12081 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012082 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012083
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012084 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012085 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012086 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012087 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12088 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012089 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012090 tcp-request content reject
12091
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012092 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12093 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12094 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12095 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12096 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12097 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12098 ...
12099 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012101 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012102 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12103 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12104 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012105 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012106
12107 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12108 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12109 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012110 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012111 tcp-request content reject
12112
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012113 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012114 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012115 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012116 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012117 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12118 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012119
12120 Example:
12121 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12122 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012123 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012125 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012126 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012127
12128 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012129 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012130 # protecting all our sites
12131 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012132 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12133 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012134 ...
12135 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12136
12137 backend http_dynamic
12138 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012139 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012140 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012141 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012142 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012143 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012144 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012146 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012147
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012148 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12149 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012150
12151
12152tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12153 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012155 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012156 Arguments :
12157 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12158 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12159 as explained at the top of this document.
12160
12161 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12162 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12163 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12164 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12165 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12166
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012167 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12168 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12169 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12170 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12171
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012172 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12173 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012174 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012175 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012176 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12177 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12178 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12179 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012180
12181 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12182 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12183 it pass through unaffected.
12184
12185 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12186 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12187 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012188 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012189 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12190 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012191 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12192 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12193 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012194
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012195 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012196 "timeout client".
12197
12198
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012199tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12200 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12202 no | no | yes | yes
12203 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012204 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12205 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012206
12207 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12208
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012209 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012210 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12211 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012212 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12213 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012214
12215 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12216
12217 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12218 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12219 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12220 inserted.
12221
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012222 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012223 - accept :
12224 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12225 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12226 the rules evaluation.
12227
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012228 - close :
12229 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12230 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12231 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12232 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12233 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12234 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012235 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012236 protocols.
12237
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012238 - reject :
12239 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12240 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012241 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012242
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012243 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12244 Sets a variable.
12245
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012246 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12247 Unsets a variable.
12248
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012249 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12250 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12251 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12252 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12253
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012254 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12255 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12256 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12257 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12258
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012259 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12260 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12261 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12262 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12263 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012264
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012265 - "silent-drop" :
12266 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012267 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012268 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12269 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12270 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12271 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12272 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012273 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12274 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012275 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12276 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012277 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012278 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12279 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12280 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12281 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12282
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012283 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12284 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12285
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012286 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12287 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12288 for changing the default action to a reject.
12289
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012290 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12291 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12292 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12293 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012294 period.
12295
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012296 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12297 declared inline.
12298
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012299 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12300 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012301 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012302 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12303 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012304 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012305 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012306 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012307 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12308 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012309 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012310 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12311 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012312
12313 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12314 followed by some converters.
12315
12316 Example:
12317
12318 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12319
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012320 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12321 <var-name>.
12322
12323 Example:
12324
12325 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12326
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012327 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12328 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12329 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12330 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12331 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12332
12333 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12334
12335 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12336
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012337 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12338
12339 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12340
12341
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012342tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12343 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12345 no | yes | yes | no
12346 Arguments :
12347 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12348 below.
12349
12350 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012352 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012353 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12354 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12355 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12356 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12357 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12358 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12359 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012360 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012361 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12362 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12363 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12364 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12365 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12366 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12367 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12368 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12369 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12370 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12371 instead.
12372
12373 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12374 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12375 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12376 rules which may be inserted.
12377
12378 Several types of actions are supported :
12379 - accept : the request is accepted
12380 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12381 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12382 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012383 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012384 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012385 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012386 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012387 - silent-drop
12388
12389 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12390 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12391 sections for a complete description.
12392
12393 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12394 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12395 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12396
12397 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12398 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12399 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12400 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12401 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12402
12403 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12404 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12405
12406 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12407 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12408 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12409
12410 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12411 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12412 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12413
12414 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12415 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12416 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12417
12418 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12419 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12420 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12421
12422 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12423
12424 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12425
12426
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012427tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12428 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12430 no | no | yes | yes
12431 Arguments :
12432 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12433 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12434 as explained at the top of this document.
12435
12436 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12437
12438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012439timeout check <timeout>
12440 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12441 established.
12442
12443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12444 yes | no | yes | yes
12445 Arguments:
12446 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12447 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12448 as explained at the top of this document.
12449
12450 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12451 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012452 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012453 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012454 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12455 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12456 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012457
12458 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12459 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12460
12461 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12462 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012463 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012464
12465 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12466 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12467 forget about it.
12468
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012469 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12470 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012471
12472
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012473timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012474 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12476 yes | yes | yes | no
12477 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012478 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012479 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12480 as explained at the top of this document.
12481
12482 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12483 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12484 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012485 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12486 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12487 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12488 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012489 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12490 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12491 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012492 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012493 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012494 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12495 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012496 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12497 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012498
12499 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12500 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12501 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12502 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012503 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012504 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12505
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012506 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012507
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012508 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012509
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012510
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012511timeout client-fin <timeout>
12512 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12514 yes | yes | yes | no
12515 Arguments :
12516 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12517 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12518 as explained at the top of this document.
12519
12520 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12521 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12522 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12523 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12524 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12525 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12526 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012527 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12528 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12529 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012530
12531 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12532 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12533 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12534
12535 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12536
12537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012538timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012539 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12541 yes | no | yes | yes
12542 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012543 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012544 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12545 as explained at the top of this document.
12546
12547 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012548 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012549 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012550 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012551 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12552 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012553
12554 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12555 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12556 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12557 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012558 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012559 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12560
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012561 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012563
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012564timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12565 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12567 yes | yes | yes | yes
12568 Arguments :
12569 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12570 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12571 as explained at the top of this document.
12572
12573 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12574 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12575 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12576 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12577 once the request has started to present itself.
12578
12579 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12580 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12581 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12582 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12583 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12584
12585 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12586 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12587 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12588 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12589
12590 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12591 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012592 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012593 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12594 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012595 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012596
12597 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12598 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12599 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12600 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12601
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012602 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12603 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012604 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12605
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012606 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12607
12608
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012609timeout http-request <timeout>
12610 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012612 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012613 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012614 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012615 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12616 as explained at the top of this document.
12617
12618 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12619 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12620 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12621 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12622 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12623 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12624 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012625 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12626 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12627 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12628 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012629 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012630 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12631 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012632
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012633 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12634 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12635 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12636 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12637 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012638 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012639
12640 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12641 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012642 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012643 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12644 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12645
12646 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012647 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12648 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12649 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012650
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012651 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012652 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012653
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012654
12655timeout queue <timeout>
12656 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12658 yes | no | yes | yes
12659 Arguments :
12660 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12661 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12662 as explained at the top of this document.
12663
12664 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12665 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12666 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12667 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12668 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12669
12670 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12671 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12672 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12673 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12674
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012675 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012676
12677
12678timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012679 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12681 yes | no | yes | yes
12682 Arguments :
12683 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12684 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12685 as explained at the top of this document.
12686
12687 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12688 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12689 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12690 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12691 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12692 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12693 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12694
12695 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12696 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12697 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12698 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12699 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012700 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012701 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012702 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12703 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012704 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12705 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012706
12707 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12708 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12709 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12710 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012711 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012712 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12713
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012714 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012715
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012716
12717timeout server-fin <timeout>
12718 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12720 yes | no | yes | yes
12721 Arguments :
12722 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12723 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12724 as explained at the top of this document.
12725
12726 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12727 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12728 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12729 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12730 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12731 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12732 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12733 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12734 situations, it should not be needed.
12735
12736 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12737 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12738 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12739
12740 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12741
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012742
12743timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012744 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12746 yes | yes | yes | yes
12747 Arguments :
12748 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12750 as explained at the top of this document.
12751
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012752 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12753 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12754 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012755
12756 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12757 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12758 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12759 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012760 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012761
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012762 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012763
12764
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012765timeout tunnel <timeout>
12766 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12768 yes | no | yes | yes
12769 Arguments :
12770 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12771 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12772 as explained at the top of this document.
12773
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012774 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012775 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12776 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12777 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012778 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12779 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012780 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12781 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12782 specified.
12783
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012784 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12785 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12786 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12787 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12788 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12789 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12790 state.
12791
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012792 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12793 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12794 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12795 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012796 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012797
12798 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12799 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12800 forget about it.
12801
12802 Example :
12803 defaults http
12804 option http-server-close
12805 timeout connect 5s
12806 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012807 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012808 timeout server 30s
12809 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12810
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012811 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012812
12813
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012814transparent (deprecated)
12815 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012817 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012818 Arguments : none
12819
12820 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12821 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12822 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12823 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12824 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12825 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12826 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12827 appropriate server.
12828
12829 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12830
12831 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12832 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12833
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012834 See also: "option transparent"
12835
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012836unique-id-format <string>
12837 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12839 yes | yes | yes | no
12840 Arguments :
12841 <string> is a log-format string.
12842
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012843 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12844 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12845 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12846 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012847
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012848 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12849 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12850 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12851 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12852 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12853 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12854 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12855 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012856
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012857 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12858 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012859
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012860 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012861
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012862 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012863
12864 will generate:
12865
12866 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12867
12868 See also: "unique-id-header"
12869
12870unique-id-header <name>
12871 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12873 yes | yes | yes | no
12874 Arguments :
12875 <name> is the name of the header.
12876
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012877 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12878 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012879
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012880 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012881
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012882 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012883 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12884
12885 will generate:
12886
12887 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12888
12889 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012890
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012891use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012892 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12894 no | yes | yes | no
12895 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012896 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12897 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012898
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012899 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12900 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012901
12902 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12903 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12904 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012905 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012906 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012907 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12908 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012909
12910 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12911 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12912 assign the backend.
12913
12914 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12915 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12916 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12917 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12918 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12919 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12920
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012921 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012922 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012923 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12924 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12925 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12926
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012927 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12928 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12929 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12930 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12931 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12932 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12933 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12934 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12935 cannot be forced from the request.
12936
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012937 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012938 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12939 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12940
12941 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12942 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012943
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012944use-fcgi-app <name>
12945 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12947 no | no | yes | yes
12948 Arguments :
12949 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12950
12951 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012952
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012953use-server <server> if <condition>
12954use-server <server> unless <condition>
12955 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12957 no | no | yes | yes
12958 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012959 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12960 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012961
12962 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12963
12964 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12965 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12966 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12967
12968 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12969 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12970 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12971 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12972 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12973 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12974 matches will assign the server.
12975
12976 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12977 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12978 with the next rules until one matches.
12979
12980 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12981 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12982 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12983 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12984
12985 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12986 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12987 stripped.
12988
12989 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12990 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012991 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12992 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12993 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012994
12995 Example :
12996 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12997 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12998 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12999 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013000 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013001 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013002 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013003 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13004 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13005
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013006 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13007 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13008 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13009 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013010 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013011 and we fall back to load balancing.
13012
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013013 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013014
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013015
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130165. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013017--------------------------
13018
13019The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13020depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13021settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13022written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13023described in this section.
13024
13025
130265.1. Bind options
13027-----------------
13028
13029The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13030as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13031no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13032parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13033while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13034provided immediately after the setting name.
13035
13036The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13037
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013038accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13039 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13040 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13041 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13042 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13043 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13044 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13045 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13046 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13047 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013048 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13049 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13050 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013051
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013052accept-proxy
13053 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013054 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13055 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013056 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13057 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13058 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13059 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013060 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013061 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13062 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013063 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13064 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013065
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013066allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013067 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013068 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013069 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013070 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13071 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013072
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013073alpn <protocols>
13074 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13075 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13076 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013077 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013078 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013079 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13080 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13081 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13082 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13083 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13084 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13085 preference, like below :
13086
13087 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013089backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013090 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013091 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13092
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013093curves <curves>
13094 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13095 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13096 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13097 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13098 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13099 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13100
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013101ecdhe <named curve>
13102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013103 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13104 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013105
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013106ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013107 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13108 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13109 client's certificate.
13110
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013111ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13113 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13114 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13115 error is ignored.
13116
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013117ca-sign-file <cafile>
13118 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13119 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13120 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13121 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13122 'generate-certificates' for details.
13123
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013124ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13126 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13127 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13128 'generate-certificates' for details.
13129
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013130ca-verify-file <cafile>
13131 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13132 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13133 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13134 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13135 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13136
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013137ciphers <ciphers>
13138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13139 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013140 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013141 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013142 information and recommendations see e.g.
13143 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13144 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13145 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13146
13147ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13148 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13149 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13150 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13151 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013152 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13153 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013154
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013155crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013156 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13157 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13158 to verify client's certificate.
13159
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013160crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13162 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13163 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13164 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13165 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013166 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13167 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013168
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013169 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13170 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13171
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013172 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13173 are loaded.
13174
13175 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013176 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13177 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13178 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13179 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13180 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13181 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13182 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013183 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013184
13185 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13186 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13187 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13188 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013189 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13190 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013191
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013192 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013193
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013194 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013195 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013196 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13197 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013198 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13199 clients).
13200
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013201 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13202 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13203 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13204 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13205 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13206 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13207 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13208 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13209 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13210 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13211 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13212 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13213 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13214
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013215 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13216 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13217 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13218 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13219 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13220
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013221 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13222 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13223 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13224 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013225
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013226 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13227 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13228 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013229
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013230crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013232 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013233 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013234 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013235
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013236crt-list <file>
13237 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013238 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13239 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013240
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013241 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13242
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013243 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13244 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13245 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13246 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13247 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013248
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013249 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013250 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13251 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13252 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13253 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13254 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013255 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13256 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13257 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013258
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013259 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13260 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13261 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013262
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013263 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13264
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013265 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13266 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13267 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13268 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13269 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13270 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13271 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13272 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013273
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013274 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013275 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013276 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013277 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013278 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013279 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013280
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013281defer-accept
13282 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13283 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13284 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013285 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013286 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13287 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13288 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13289 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13290 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13291 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13292 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13293
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013294expose-fd listeners
13295 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13296 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013297 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13298 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013299 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013300
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013301force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013302 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013303 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013304 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013305 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013306
13307force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013308 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013309 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013310 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013311
13312force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013313 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013314 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013315 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013316
13317force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013318 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013319 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013320 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013321
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013322force-tlsv13
13323 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13324 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013325 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013326
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013327generate-certificates
13328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13329 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13330 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13331 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13332 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13333 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13334 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13335 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13336 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13337 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13338 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13339
13340 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13341 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013342 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013343 certificate is used many times.
13344
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013345gid <gid>
13346 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13347 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13348 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13349 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13350 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13351
13352group <group>
13353 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13354 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13355 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13356 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13357 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13358
13359id <id>
13360 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13361 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13362 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13363 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13364
13365interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013366 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13367 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13368 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13369 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13370 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13371 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013372 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13373 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13374 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13375 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13376 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13377 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013378
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013379level <level>
13380 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13381 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13382 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013383 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013384 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13385 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13386 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013387 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013388 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013389 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013390 all counters).
13391
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013392severity-output <format>
13393 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13394 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13395 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13396 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13397 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13398 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13399 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13400 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13401 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13402 rfc5424 convention.
13403
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013404maxconn <maxconn>
13405 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13406 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13407 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13408 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13409 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13410 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13411 eat all memory.
13412
13413mode <mode>
13414 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13415 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13416 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13417 UNIX sockets.
13418
13419mss <maxseg>
13420 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13421 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13422 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13423 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13424 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13425 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13426 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13427 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13428 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13429 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13430 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13431
13432name <name>
13433 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13434 page.
13435
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013436namespace <name>
13437 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13438 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13439 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13440 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13441
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013442nice <nice>
13443 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13444 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13445 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13446 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13447 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13448 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13449 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13450 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13451 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13452 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13453 one for an RDP socket.
13454
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013455no-ca-names
13456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13457 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013458 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013459
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013460no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013462 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013463 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013464 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013465 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13466 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013467
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013468no-tls-tickets
13469 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13470 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13471 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013472 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13473 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013474 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13475 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13476 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013477
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013478no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013480 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013481 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013482 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013483 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13484 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013485
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013486no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013487 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013488 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013489 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013490 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013491 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13492 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013493
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013494no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013495 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013496 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013497 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013498 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013499 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13500 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013501
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013502no-tlsv13
13503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13504 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13505 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13506 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013507 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13508 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013509
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013510npn <protocols>
13511 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13512 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13513 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013514 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013515 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013516 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13517 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13518 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13519 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13520 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013521
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013522prefer-client-ciphers
13523 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13524 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13525 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013526 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13527 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13528 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013529
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013530process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013531 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013532 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013533 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013534 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13535 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13536 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13537 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013538 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013539 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13540 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13541 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13542 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13543 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013544
13545 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13546
13547 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13548 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13549 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13550 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13551 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13552 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13553 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13554 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013555
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013556proto <name>
13557 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13558 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13559 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013560 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13561 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13562
13563 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13564 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13565 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13566 also reported (flag=HTX).
13567
13568 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13569 a bind line :
13570
13571 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13572 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13573 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13574
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013575 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013576 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013577 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013578 h2" on the bind line.
13579
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013580ssl
13581 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013582 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013583 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13584 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013585 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13586 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013587
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013588ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13589 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013590 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13591 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13592 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013593 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13594
13595ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013596 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13597 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13598 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13599 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013600
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013601strict-sni
13602 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13603 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13604 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13605 See the "crt" option for more information.
13606
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013607tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013608 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013609 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13610 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013611 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013612 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13613 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13614 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13615 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13616 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13617 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13618 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13619
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013620tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013621 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013622 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13623 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13624 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13625 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13626 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13627 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13628 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013629 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13630 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13631 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013632
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013633tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13634 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013635 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13636 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13637 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13638 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13639 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13640 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13641 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13642 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13643 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13644 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013645 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13646 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13647
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013648transparent
13649 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13650 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13651 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13652 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13653 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13654 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13655 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13656 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13657 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13658 so check for support with your vendor.
13659
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013660v4v6
13661 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13662 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13663 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13664 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013665 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013666
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013667v6only
13668 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13669 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13670 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013671 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13672 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013673
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013674uid <uid>
13675 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13676 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13677 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13678 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13679 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13680
13681user <user>
13682 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13683 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13684 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13685 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13686 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13687
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013688verify [none|optional|required]
13689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13690 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13691 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13692 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13693 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013694 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13695 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13696 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13697 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013698
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200136995.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013700------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013702The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13703which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13704arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13705settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13706after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13707Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13708address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013710 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013711 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013712
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013713Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13714keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013716The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013717
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013718addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013719 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013720 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13721 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13722 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13723 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13724 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013725
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013726agent-check
13727 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013728 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013729 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13730 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13731 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013732
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013733 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013734 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013735 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13736 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13737 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013738
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013739 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13740 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13741 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13742 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13743 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013744
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013745 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013746 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013747
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013748 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13749 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13750 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013751
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013752 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13753 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13754 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013755
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013756 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013757 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13758 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13759 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13760 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013761 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013762 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013763
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013764 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13765 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013766
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013767 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13768 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13769 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13770 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13771 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13772 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13773 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13774 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13775 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013776
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013777 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13778 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013779 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13780 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13781 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013782 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013783
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013784 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013785 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013786
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013787agent-send <string>
13788 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13789 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13790 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13791 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13792 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13793
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013794agent-inter <delay>
13795 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13796 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13797
13798 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13799 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13800 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13801 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13802 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13803 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13804 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13805 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13806 of backends use the same servers.
13807
13808 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13809
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013810agent-addr <addr>
13811 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13812
13813 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13814 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13815 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13816 hostname, it will be resolved.
13817
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013818agent-port <port>
13819 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13820
13821 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13822
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013823allow-0rtt
13824 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013825 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13826 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013827
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013828alpn <protocols>
13829 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13830 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13831 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013832 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013833 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13834 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13835 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13836 now obsolete NPN extension.
13837 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13838 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13839
13840 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013842backup
13843 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13844 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13845 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13846 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013847 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13848 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013849
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013850ca-file <cafile>
13851 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13852 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13853 server's certificate.
13854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013855check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013856 This option enables health checks on a server:
13857 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13858 considered available.
13859 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13860 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13861 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13862 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13863 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13864 set.
13865 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13866 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13867 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13868 exchanges succeed.
13869
13870 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13871 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13872 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13873 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13874 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013875 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013876 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13877
13878 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13879 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13880
13881 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13882 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13883
13884 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13885 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13886 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13887 available.
13888
13889 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13890 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13891 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13892
13893 Example:
13894 # simple tcp check
13895 backend foo
13896 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13897 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13898 backend foo
13899 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13900 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13901 backend foo
13902 option tcp-check
13903 tcp-check connect
13904 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013905
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013906check-send-proxy
13907 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13908 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13909 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13910 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13911 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13912 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13913 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13914
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013915check-alpn <protocols>
13916 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13917 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13918 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13919
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013920check-proto <name>
13921 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13922 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13923 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013924 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
13925 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13926
13927 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13928 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13929 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13930 also reported (flag=HTX).
13931
13932 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
13933 directive on a server line:
13934
13935 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13936 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13937 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13938 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13939
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013940 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013941 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13942 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13943
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013944check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013945 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013946 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13947 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013948
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013949check-ssl
13950 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13951 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13952 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13953 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013954 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013955 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13956 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013957 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013958 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13959 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013960
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013961check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013962 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013963 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13964 for normal traffic.
13965
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013966ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013967 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13968 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13969 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013970 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13971 information and recommendations see e.g.
13972 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13973 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13974 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013975
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013976ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13977 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13978 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13979 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13980 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013981 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13982 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13983 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013985cookie <value>
13986 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13987 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13988 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13989 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13990 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13991 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13992 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13993
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013994crl-file <crlfile>
13995 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13996 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13997 to verify server's certificate.
13998
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013999crt <cert>
14000 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14001 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14002 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14003 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14004 certificate request.
14005
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014006disabled
14007 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14008 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14009 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14010 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14011 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014012 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014013
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014014enabled
14015 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14016 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14017 default value.
14018 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14019 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014021error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014022 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14023 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14024 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014026 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014028fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014029 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14030 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14031 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14032
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014033force-sslv3
14034 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14035 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014036 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014037 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014038
14039force-tlsv10
14040 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014041 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014042 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014043
14044force-tlsv11
14045 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014046 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014047 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014048
14049force-tlsv12
14050 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014051 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014052 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014053
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014054force-tlsv13
14055 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14056 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014057 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014059id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014060 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14061 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14062 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014063
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014064init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14065 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14066 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014067 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014068 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14069 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14070 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14071 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14072 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14073 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14074 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14075 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14076 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014077 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014078 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14079 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14080 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14081 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14082 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14083 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014084 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014085
14086 Example:
14087 defaults
14088 # never fail on address resolution
14089 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14090
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014091inter <delay>
14092fastinter <delay>
14093downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014094 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14095 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14096 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14097 between checks depending on the server state :
14098
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014099 Server state | Interval used
14100 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14101 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14102 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14103 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14104 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14105 or yet unchecked. |
14106 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14107 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14108 | "inter" otherwise.
14109 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014111 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14112 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14113 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14114 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014115 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14116 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14117 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14118 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14119 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014120
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014121log-proto <logproto>
14122 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14123 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14124 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14125 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014127maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014128 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14129 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014130 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14131 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014132 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14133 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14134 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14135 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14136
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014137 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14138 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14139 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14140 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14141 than 50 concurrent requests.
14142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014143maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014144 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14145 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14146 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14147 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014148 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14149 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14150 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14151 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14152 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14153 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14154 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014155
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014156max-reuse <count>
14157 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14158 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14159 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14160 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14161 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14162 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14163 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14164 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014166minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014167 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14168 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14169 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14170 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14171 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14172 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014173 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014174 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014175
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014176namespace <name>
14177 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14178 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14179 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14180 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14181
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014182no-agent-check
14183 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14184 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14185 default value.
14186 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14187 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14188
14189no-backup
14190 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14191 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14192 default value.
14193 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14194 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14195
14196no-check
14197 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14198 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14199 default value.
14200 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14201 "default-server" "check" setting.
14202
14203no-check-ssl
14204 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14205 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14206 default value.
14207 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14208 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14209
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014210no-send-proxy
14211 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14212 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14213 default value.
14214 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14215 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14216
14217no-send-proxy-v2
14218 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14219 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14220 default value.
14221 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14222 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14223
14224no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14225 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14226 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14227 default value.
14228 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14229 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14230
14231no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14232 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14233 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14234 default value.
14235 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14236 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14237
14238no-ssl
14239 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14240 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14241 default value.
14242 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14243 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14244
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014245 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14246 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14247 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14248
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014249no-ssl-reuse
14250 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14251 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14252 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14253 and for paranoid users.
14254
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014255no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014256 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14257 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014258 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014259
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014260 Supported in default-server: No
14261
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014262no-tls-tickets
14263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14264 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14265 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014266 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14267 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014268 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14269 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14270 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014271 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014272
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014273no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014274 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014275 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14276 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014277 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14278 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014279 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014280
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014281 Supported in default-server: No
14282
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014283no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014284 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014285 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14286 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014287 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14288 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014289 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014290
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014291 Supported in default-server: No
14292
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014293no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014294 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014295 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14296 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014297 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14298 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014299 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014300
14301 Supported in default-server: No
14302
14303no-tlsv13
14304 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14305 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14306 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14307 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14308 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014309 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014310
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014311 Supported in default-server: No
14312
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014313no-verifyhost
14314 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14315 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14316 default value.
14317 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14318 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014319
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014320no-tfo
14321 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14322 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14323 default value.
14324 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14325 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14326
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014327non-stick
14328 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14329 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14330 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14331
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014332npn <protocols>
14333 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14334 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14335 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014336 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014337 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14338 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14339 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014341observe <mode>
14342 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14343 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14344 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14345 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14346 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14347 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014348 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014349
14350 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014352on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014353 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14354 Currently, four modes are available:
14355 - fastinter: force fastinter
14356 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14357 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14358 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14359 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14360
14361 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14362
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014363on-marked-down <action>
14364 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14365 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014366 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14367 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14368 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14369 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14370 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14371 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14372 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14373 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014374
14375 Actions are disabled by default
14376
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014377on-marked-up <action>
14378 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14379 Currently one action is available:
14380 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14381 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14382 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14383 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014384 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14385 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014386 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14387 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14388
14389 Actions are disabled by default
14390
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014391pool-low-conn <max>
14392 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14393 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14394 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14395 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14396 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14397 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14398 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14399 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14400 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14401 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014402 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14403 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14404 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14405 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014406
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014407pool-max-conn <max>
14408 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14409 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14410 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14411 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14412 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14413 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14414
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014415pool-purge-delay <delay>
14416 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014417 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014418 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014420port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014421 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014422 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14423 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14424 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14425 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14426 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014427
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014428proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014429 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14430 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14431 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014432 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14433 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14434
14435 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14436 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14437 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14438 also reported (flag=HTX).
14439
14440 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14441 a server line :
14442
14443 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14444 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14445 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14446 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14447
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014448 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014449 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014451redir <prefix>
14452 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14453 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14454 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14455 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14456 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14457 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14458 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14459 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014460 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014461 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014462 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14463 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14464 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14465 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14466
14467 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014469rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014470 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14471 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14472 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14473
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014474resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14475 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14476 server.
14477
14478 Available options:
14479
14480 * allow-dup-ip
14481 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14482 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14483 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14484 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14485 For such case, simply enable this option.
14486 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14487
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014488 * ignore-weight
14489 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14490 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14491 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14492
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014493 * prevent-dup-ip
14494 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14495 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14496 same fqdn.
14497 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14498
14499 Example:
14500 backend b_myapp
14501 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14502 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14503 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14504
14505 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14506 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14507 it
14508 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14509 different address
14510
14511 Default value: not set
14512
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014513resolve-prefer <family>
14514 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14515 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14516 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14517 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14518
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014519 Default value: ipv6
14520
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014521 Example:
14522
14523 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014524
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014525resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014526 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014527 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014528 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014529 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14530 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014531 configured network, another address is selected.
14532
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014533 Example:
14534
14535 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014536
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014537resolvers <id>
14538 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14539 hostname.
14540
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014541 Example:
14542
14543 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014544
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014545 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014546
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014547send-proxy
14548 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14549 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14550 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14551 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014552 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14553 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14554 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14555 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14556 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14557 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14558 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14559 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14560 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14561 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014562 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14563 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014564
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014565send-proxy-v2
14566 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14567 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14568 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14569 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014570 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14571 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14572 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14573 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014574
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014575proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014576 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14577 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14578
14579 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14580 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14581 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14582 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14583 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14584 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14585 connection is supported).
14586 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14587 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14588 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14589 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14590 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14591 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14592 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014593
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014594send-proxy-v2-ssl
14595 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14596 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14597 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14598 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14599 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14600 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14601 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014602 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14603 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014604
14605send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14606 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14607 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14608 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14609 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14610 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14611 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14612 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14613 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014614 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14615 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014617slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014618 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14619 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14620 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14621 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14622 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14623 parameters :
14624
14625 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14626 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14627
14628 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14629 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14630 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14631 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14632
14633 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14634 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14635 seen as failed.
14636
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014637sni <expression>
14638 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14639 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14640 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14641 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014642 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14643 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014644 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014645 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14646 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014647
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014648source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014649source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014650source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014651 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14652 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14653 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14654 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14655
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014656 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14657 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14658 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14659 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14660 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14661 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14662 server.
14663
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014664 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14665 specifying the source address without port(s).
14666
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014667ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014668 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14669 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14670 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14671 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14672 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14673 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014674 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14675 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014676
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014677ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14678 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14679 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14680 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14681
14682ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14683 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14684 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14685 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14686
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014687ssl-reuse
14688 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14689 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14690 default value.
14691 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14692 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14693
14694stick
14695 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14696 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14697 default value.
14698 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14699 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014700
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014701socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014702 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014703 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14704 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14705
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014706tcp-ut <delay>
14707 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14708 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14709 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014710 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014711 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14712 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14713 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14714 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14715 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14716 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14717 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14718 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14719 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14720
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014721tfo
14722 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14723 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14724 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14725 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14726 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014727 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014729track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014730 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14731 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14732 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14733 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014734 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14735
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014736tls-tickets
14737 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14738 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14739 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014740 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14741 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14742 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014743 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014744 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014745
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014746verify [none|required]
14747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014748 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014749 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14750 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014751 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014752 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14753 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14754 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14755 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14756 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14757 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14758 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14759 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014760
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014761verifyhost <hostname>
14762 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014763 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14764 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14765 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14766 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14767 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14768 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14769 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14770 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014772weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014773 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14774 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14775 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014776 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14777 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14778 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14779 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14780 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14781 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014782
14783
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200147845.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14785-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014786
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014787HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14788using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014789configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014790This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14791can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14792workload.
14793This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14794resolution at run time.
14795Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14796carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14797
14798
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200147995.3.1. Global overview
14800----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014801
14802As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14803different steps of the process life:
14804
14805 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14806 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14807 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14808
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014809 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14810 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014811
14812A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14813 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14814 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14815 resolution to know this new IP.
14816
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014817When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014818HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014819SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14820from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14821will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14822will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014823
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014824A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014825 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014826 first valid response.
14827
14828 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14829 servers return an error.
14830
14831
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200148325.3.2. The resolvers section
14833----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014834
14835This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014836HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14837contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014838
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014839When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14840uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14841is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14842answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14843
14844When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014845used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014846
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014847 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14848 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14849 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014850
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014851 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14852 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014853
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014854 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14855 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14856 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014857
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014858For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14859following scenarios are possible:
14860
14861 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14862 ignored
14863
14864 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14865 applied
14866
14867 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14868 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14869
14870 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14871 retries the query with a new type
14872
14873 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14874 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014875
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014876As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14877a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014878<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014879
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014880
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014881resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014882 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014883
14884A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14885
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014886accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014887 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014888 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014889 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14890 by RFC 6891)
14891
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010014892 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
14893 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
14894 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
14895 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
14896 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
14897 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014898
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014899nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
14900 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
14901 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
14902 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
14903 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
14904 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
14905 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
14906 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
14907 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
14908 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010014909 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
14910
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014911parse-resolv-conf
14912 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14913 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14914 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14915
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014916hold <status> <period>
14917 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14918 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014919 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014920 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014921 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14922 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14923 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14924
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014925 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014926
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014927resolve_retries <nb>
14928 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14929 giving up.
14930 Default value: 3
14931
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014932 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14933 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14934 type.
14935
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014936timeout <event> <time>
14937 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14938 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14939 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014940 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14941 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014942 Default value: 1s
14943 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014944 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014945 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014946 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14947 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14948
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014949 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014950
14951 resolvers mydns
14952 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14953 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014954 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014955 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014956 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014957 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014958 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014959 hold other 30s
14960 hold refused 30s
14961 hold nx 30s
14962 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014963 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014964 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014965
14966
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200149676. Cache
14968---------
14969
14970HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14971(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14972RAM.
14973
14974The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14975this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14976
14977If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14978independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14979when we try to allocate a new one.
14980
14981The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14982
14983It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14984"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14985for more details.
14986
14987When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14988replaced by "<CACHE>".
14989
14990
149916.1. Limitation
14992----------------
14993
14994The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14995
14996- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014997- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14998 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14999 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015000- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15001- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015002- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15003 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15004 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015005- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15006 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015007- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15008 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15009 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015010
15011- If the request is not a GET
15012- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15013- If the request contains an Authorization header
15014
15015
150166.2. Setup
15017-----------
15018
15019To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15020the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15021
15022
150236.2.1. Cache section
15024---------------------
15025
15026cache <name>
15027 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15028 size of cache is mandatory.
15029
15030total-max-size <megabytes>
15031 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15032 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15033
15034max-object-size <bytes>
15035 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15036 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15037 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15038
15039max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015040 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015041 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15042 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15043 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15044 default.
15045
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015046process-vary <on/off>
15047 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015048 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15049 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15050 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015051 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015052
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015053max-secondary-entries <number>
15054 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15055 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15056 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15057
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015058
150596.2.2. Proxy section
15060---------------------
15061
15062http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15063 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15064 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15065 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15066 after this one.
15067
15068http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15069 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15070 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15071 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15072 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15073
15074
15075Example:
15076
15077 backend bck1
15078 mode http
15079
15080 http-request cache-use foobar
15081 http-response cache-store foobar
15082 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15083
15084 cache foobar
15085 total-max-size 4
15086 max-age 240
15087
15088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150897. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15090----------------------------------
15091
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015092HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15094The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15095these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15096but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15097data called patterns.
15098
15099
151007.1. ACL basics
15101---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015102
15103The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15104content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15105from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15106simple :
15107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015108 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015109 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015110 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15111 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15114adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015115
15116In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015119
15120This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15121Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15122and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015123an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15124conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15125as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15126are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015127
15128ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15129'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15130which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15131
15132There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15133performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015135The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15136specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15137this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015138methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15139ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015140
15141Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15142 - boolean
15143 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15144 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15145 - string
15146 - data block
15147
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015148Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15149converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15150would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15151The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15152which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15153
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015154Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15155keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15156fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15157which are summarized in the table below :
15158
15159 +---------------------+-----------------+
15160 | Sample or converter | Default |
15161 | output type | matching method |
15162 +---------------------+-----------------+
15163 | boolean | bool |
15164 +---------------------+-----------------+
15165 | integer | int |
15166 +---------------------+-----------------+
15167 | ip | ip |
15168 +---------------------+-----------------+
15169 | string | str |
15170 +---------------------+-----------------+
15171 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15172 +---------------------+-----------------+
15173
15174Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15175matching method, see below.
15176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15178 - boolean
15179 - integer or integer range
15180 - IP address / network
15181 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15182 - regular expression
15183 - hex block
15184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015185The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15186
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015187 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15188 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015190 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015191 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015192 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015193 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15196read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15197if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15198lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15199will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15200beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15201a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15202lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15203exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15204
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015205The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15206parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15207ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15208a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15209check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15210
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015211The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15212socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15213file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15216loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15217
15218 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15219
15220In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15221the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15222case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15223as well.
15224
15225The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15226sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15227do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15228methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15229is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015230obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15232default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15233that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15234string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15235
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015236The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15237By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15238string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15239resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15240server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015241waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015242flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15243function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15246sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15247be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015248
15249 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15250 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15252 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15253 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15254 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015255
15256 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15257 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015258 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015259
15260 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015261 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015262
15263 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015264 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015265
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015266 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015267 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15268
15269 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15270 binary or string samples.
15271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015272 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15273 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15276 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15277 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15280 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015282 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15283 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015285 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15286 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15289 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015290 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015292 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15293 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15294 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015295
15296For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15297request, it is possible to do :
15298
15299 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15300
15301In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15302buffer, one would use the following acl :
15303
15304 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15305
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015306On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15307possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15308
15309 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015311All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15312criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15313method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15314to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15315criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15316the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015319the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15320For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015322 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15323 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15324 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15325 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015326
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015327
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015328The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15329types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15330combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15331brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15332default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334 +-------------------------------------------------+
15335 | Input sample type |
15336 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015337 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015338 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15339 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15340 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015341 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015342 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015343 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015344 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015345 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015346 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015347 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015348 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015349 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015351 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015352 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015353 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015354 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015355 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015356 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015357 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015358 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015359 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015360 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015361 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015362 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15363 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15364 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015365
15366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153677.1.1. Matching booleans
15368------------------------
15369
15370In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15371Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15372When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15373that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15374
15375Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15376return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15377"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15378
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153807.1.2. Matching integers
15381------------------------
15382
15383Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15384enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15385to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15386
15387Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15388matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15389lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015390
15391For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15392unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15393representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15394
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015395As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15396two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15397instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15398ranges and operators.
15399
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015400For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015401operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15402Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15403of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015405Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015406
15407 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15408 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15409 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15410 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15411 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15412
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015413For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015414
15415 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15416
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015417This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15418
15419 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15420
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154227.1.3. Matching strings
15423-----------------------
15424
15425String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15426different forms :
15427
15428 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015429 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015430
15431 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015432 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015433
15434 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15435 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15436
15437 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15438 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15439
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015440 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15442 matches.
15443
15444 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15445 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15446 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015447
15448String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15449exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15450characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15451string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15452to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015453before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015454
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015455Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15456(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15457Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15458
15459Example:
15460 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15461 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15462
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154647.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15465---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015466
15467Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15468they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15469possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15470passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15471the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015472the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15473match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015474
15475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154767.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15477-------------------------------------
15478
15479It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15480not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15481a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15482to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15483digits may be used upper or lower case.
15484
15485Example :
15486 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15487 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15488
15489
154907.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15491---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015492
15493IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15494netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15495within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015496host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015497difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15498at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15499does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15500parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015501
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015502The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15503abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15504
15505 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15506 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15507 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15508 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15509 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15510 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15511 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15512 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15513
15514Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15515192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15516
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015517IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15518Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15519trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15520IPv6 patterns.
15521
15522HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15523following situations :
15524 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15525 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15526 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15527 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15528 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15529 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15530 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15531 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15532 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15533 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015535
155367.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15537----------------------------------
15538
15539Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15540combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15541
15542 - AND (implicit)
15543 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15544 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15551indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15554"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15555requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15556is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15557
15558 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015559 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15560 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15561 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562
15563To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15564and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15565
15566 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15567 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15568 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15569 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15570
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015571 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15573 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15574 use_backend www if host_www
15575
15576It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15577expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15578be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15579the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15580
15581 The following rule :
15582
15583 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015584 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585
15586 Can also be written that way :
15587
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015588 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589
15590It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15591to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15592simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15593sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15594good use is the following :
15595
15596 With named ACLs :
15597
15598 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15599 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15600 monitor fail if site_dead
15601
15602 With anonymous ACLs :
15603
15604 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15605
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015606See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15607keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608
15609
156107.3. Fetching samples
15611---------------------
15612
15613Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15614against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15615sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15616ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15617of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15618available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15619
15620This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15621Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15622compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15623deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15624
15625The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15626matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15627method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15628indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15629
15630As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15631when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15632mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15633the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15634ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15635
15636Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15637multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15638when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015639incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15640are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15642all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15643
15644Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15645 - name
15646 - name(arg1)
15647 - name(arg1,arg2)
15648
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015649
156507.3.1. Converters
15651-----------------
15652
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015653Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15654of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15655is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15656was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015657has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015658unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15659
15660These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15661sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15662the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015663support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015664
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015665A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15666support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15667supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15668(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15669bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015671The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015672
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001567351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15674 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15675 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15676 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15677 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15678 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15679
15680 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015681 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15682 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015683 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15684 frontend http-in
15685 bind *:8081
15686 default_backend servers
15687 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15688 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15689
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015690add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015691 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015692 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015693 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15694 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015695 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015696 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15697 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15698 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15699 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015700 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015701 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015702
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015703aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15704 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15705 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15706 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15707 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15708 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15709 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15710
15711 Example:
15712 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15713 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15714
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015715and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015716 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015717 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015718 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15719 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015720 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015721 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15722 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15723 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15724 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015725 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015726 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015727
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015728b64dec
15729 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15730 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015731 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15732 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015733
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015734base64
15735 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015736 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015737 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15738 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015739
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015740bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015741 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015742 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015743 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015744 presence of a flag).
15745
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015746bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15747 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15748 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015749 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015750
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015751concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15752 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15753 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15754 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15755 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15756 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15757 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15758 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15759 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15760 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15761 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015762 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015763 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015764 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15765 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015766
15767 Example:
15768 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15769 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15770 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015771 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015772 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15773
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015774cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015775 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15776 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015777
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015778crc32([<avalanche>])
15779 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15780 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15781 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15782 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15783 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15784 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15785 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15786 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15787 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15788 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015789 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15790
15791crc32c([<avalanche>])
15792 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15793 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15794 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15795 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15796 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15797 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15798 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15799 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015800
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015801cut_crlf
15802 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15803 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15804 updated.
15805
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015806da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015807 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15808 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15809 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15810 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015811 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015812 configuration language.
15813
15814 Example:
15815 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015816 bind *:8881
15817 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015818 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015819
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015820debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15821 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15822 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15823 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15824 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15825 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15826 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15827 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15828 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15829 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15830 printable sample types.
15831
15832 Example:
15833 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015834
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015835digest(<algorithm>)
15836 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15837 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15838
15839 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15840 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15841
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015842div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015843 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15844 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015845 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015846 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15847 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015848 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015849 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15850 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15851 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15852 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015853 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015854 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015855
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015856djb2([<avalanche>])
15857 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15858 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15859 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15860 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15861 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15862 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15863 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015864 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15865 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015866
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015867even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015868 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015869 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15870
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015871field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15872 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15873 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15874 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15875 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15876 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15877 fields.
15878
15879 Example :
15880 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15881 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15882 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15883 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15884 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015885
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015886fix_is_valid
15887 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15888 Information eXchange):
15889
15890 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15891 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015892 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015893 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010015894 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015895 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15896 checksum
15897
15898 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15899 the server can be parsed.
15900
15901 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15902 message, false if not.
15903
15904 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15905
15906 Example:
15907 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15908 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15909
15910fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15911 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15912 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15913 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15914 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050015915 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015916 added.
15917
15918 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15919 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15920 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15921 fix_is_valid converter.
15922
15923 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15924
15925 Example:
15926 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15927 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15928 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15929 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15930 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15931
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015932hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015933 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015934 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015935 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015936 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015937
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015938hex2i
15939 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015940 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015941
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015942htonl
15943 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15944 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15945 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15946 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15947
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015948hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015949 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15950 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15951 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15952 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15953
15954 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15955 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15956
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015957http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015958 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15959 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015960 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15961 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15962 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15963 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15964 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15965 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15966 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15967 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015969iif(<true>,<false>)
15970 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15971 string otherwise.
15972
15973 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015974 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015975
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015976in_table(<table>)
15977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15979 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015980 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015981 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15982
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015983ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015984 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015985 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015986 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15987 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15988 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15989 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15990 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015991
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015992json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015993 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015994 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015995 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015996 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15997 of errors:
15998 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15999 bytes, ...)
16000 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16001 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16002
16003 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16004 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16005 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16006 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16007 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16008 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016009 - "ascii" : never fails;
16010 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16011 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016012 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016013 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016014 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16015 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16016
16017 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016018 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016019
16020 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016021 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016022 capture request header user-agent len 150
16023 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016024
16025 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16026 GET / HTTP/1.0
16027 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16028
16029 Output log:
16030 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16031
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016032json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16033 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16034 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16035 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16036 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16037
16038 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16039 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16040
16041 Example:
16042 # get a integer value from the request body
16043 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16044 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16045
16046 # get a key with '.' in the name
16047 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16048 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16049
16050 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16051 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16052
16053 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16054 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16055
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016056language(<value>[,<default>])
16057 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16058 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16059 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16060 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16061 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16062 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16063 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16064 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16065 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016066 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016067 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16068 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016069
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016070 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016071
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016072 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16073 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016074
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016075 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16076 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16077 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16078 use_backend spanish if es
16079 use_backend french if fr
16080 use_backend english if en
16081 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016082
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016083length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016084 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16085 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16086 type. The result is of type integer.
16087
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016088lower
16089 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16090 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16091 type. The result is of type string.
16092
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016093ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16094 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16095 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16096 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16097 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16098 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16099 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16100
16101 Example :
16102
16103 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016104 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016105 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16106
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016107ltrim(<chars>)
16108 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16109 representation of the input sample.
16110
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016111map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16112map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16113map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16114 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16115 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16116 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16117 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16118 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16119 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16120 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16121 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016122
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016123 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16124 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16125 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016126
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016127 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016128 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016129
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016130 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16131 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16132 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16133 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016134 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16135 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016136 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16137 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16138 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16139 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16140 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16141 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16142 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16143 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016144 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16145 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16146 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016147 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16148 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16149 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16150 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16151 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016152
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016153 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16154 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16155 the corresponding match text.
16156
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016157 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16158 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16159 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16160 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16161 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016162
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016163 Example :
16164
16165 # this is a comment and is ignored
16166 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16167 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16168 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16169 | | | `---------- value
16170 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16171 | `---------------------------- key
16172 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16173
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016174mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016175 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16176 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016177 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016178 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016179 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016180 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16181 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16182 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16183 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016184 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016185 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016186
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016187mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
16188 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16189 <packettype>.
16190 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16191 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16192 from.
16193 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16194 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16195 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16196
16197 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16198 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16199 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16200 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16201
16202 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16203 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16204 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16205 packets only):
16206 17: Session Expiry Interval
16207 33: Receive Maximum
16208 39: Maximum Packet Size
16209 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16210 25: Request Response Information
16211 23: Request Problem Information
16212 21: Authentication Method
16213 22: Authentication Data
16214 18: Will Delay Interval
16215 1: Payload Format Indicator
16216 2: Message Expiry Interval
16217 3: Content Type
16218 8: Response Topic
16219 9: Correlation Data
16220 Not supported yet:
16221 38: User Property
16222
16223 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16224 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16225 packets only):
16226 17: Session Expiry Interval
16227 33: Receive Maximum
16228 36: Maximum QoS
16229 37: Retain Available
16230 39: Maximum Packet Size
16231 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16232 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16233 31: Reason String
16234 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16235 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16236 42: Shared Subscription Available
16237 19: Server Keep Alive
16238 26: Response Information
16239 28: Server Reference
16240 21: Authentication Method
16241 22: Authentication Data
16242 Not supported yet:
16243 38: User Property
16244
16245 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16246 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16247 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16248 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16249
16250 Example:
16251
16252 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16253 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16254 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16255 if data_in_buffer
16256 # do the same as above
16257 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16258 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16259 if data_in_buffer
16260
16261mqtt_is_valid
16262 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16263
16264 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16265 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16266 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16267 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16268
16269 Example:
16270
16271 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16272 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16273
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016274mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016275 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016276 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16277 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016278 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016279 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016280 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016281 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16282 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16283 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16284 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016285 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016286 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016287
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016288nbsrv
16289 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16290 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16291 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16292 map lookup.
16293
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016294neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016295 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16296 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16297 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16298 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016299
16300not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016301 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016302 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016303 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016304 absence of a flag).
16305
16306odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016307 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016308 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16309
16310or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016311 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016312 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016313 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16314 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016315 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016316 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16317 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16318 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16319 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016320 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016321 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016322
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016323protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16324 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16325 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16326 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16327 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16328 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16329 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16330 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16331 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16332 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16333 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16334 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16335
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016336regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016337 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16338 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16339 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16340 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16341 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16342 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16343 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16344 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16345 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016346 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16347 of characters with other ones.
16348
16349 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16350 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16351 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16352 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16353 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16354 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016355
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016356 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016357
16358 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16359 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16360 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016361 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016362
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016363 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16364 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16365
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016366 # capture groups and backreferences
16367 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016368 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016369 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16370
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016371capture-req(<id>)
16372 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16373 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16374
16375 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016376 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16377 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016378
16379capture-res(<id>)
16380 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16381 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16382
16383 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016384 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16385 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016386
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016387rtrim(<chars>)
16388 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16389 of the input sample.
16390
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016391sdbm([<avalanche>])
16392 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16393 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16394 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16395 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16396 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16397 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16398 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016399 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16400 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016401
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016402secure_memcmp(<var>)
16403 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16404 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16405 match.
16406
16407 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16408 performed in constant time.
16409
16410 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16411 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16412
16413 Example :
16414
16415 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16416 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16417 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16418 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16419
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016420set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016421 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16422 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16423 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016424 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016425 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16426 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016427 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016428 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16429 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016430 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016431 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016432
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016433sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016434 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016435 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16436
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016437sha2([<bits>])
16438 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16439 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16440
16441 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16442 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16443
16444 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16445 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16446
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016447srv_queue
16448 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16449 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16450 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16451 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16452 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16453
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016454strcmp(<var>)
16455 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16456 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16457 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16458 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16459 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16460 shorter).
16461
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016462 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16463 strings in constant time.
16464
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016465 Example :
16466
16467 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16468 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16469 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16470
16471
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016472sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016473 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16474 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016475 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016476 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16477 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016478 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016479 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16480 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016481 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016482 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16483 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016484 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016485 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016486
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016487table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16488 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16489 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16490 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16491 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16492 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16493 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16494
16495
16496table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16497 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16498 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16499 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16500 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16501 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16502 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16503
16504table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16505 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16506 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016507 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016508 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16509 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16510
16511table_conn_cur(<table>)
16512 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16513 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16514 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16515 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16516 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16517
16518table_conn_rate(<table>)
16519 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16520 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16521 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16522 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16523 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16524
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016525table_gpt0(<table>)
16526 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16527 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16528 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16529 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16530 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16531
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016532table_gpc0(<table>)
16533 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16534 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16535 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16536 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16537 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16538
16539table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16540 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16541 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16542 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16543 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16544 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16545 sample fetch keyword.
16546
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016547table_gpc1(<table>)
16548 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16549 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16550 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16551 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16552 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16553
16554table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16555 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16556 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16557 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16558 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16559 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16560 sample fetch keyword.
16561
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016562table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16563 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16564 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016565 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016566 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16567 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16568
16569table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16570 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16571 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16572 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16573 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16574 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16575 keyword.
16576
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016577table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16578 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16579 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16580 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16581 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16582 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16583
16584table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16585 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16586 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16587 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16588 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16589 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16590 keyword.
16591
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016592table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16593 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16594 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016595 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016596 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16597 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16598
16599table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16600 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16601 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16602 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16603 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16604 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16605 keyword.
16606
16607table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16608 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16609 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016610 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016611 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16612 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16613 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16614 keyword.
16615
16616table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16617 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16618 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016619 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016620 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16621 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16622 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16623 keyword.
16624
16625table_server_id(<table>)
16626 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16627 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16628 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16629 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16630 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16631 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16632
16633table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16634 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16635 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016636 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016637 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16638 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16639 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16640 keyword.
16641
16642table_sess_rate(<table>)
16643 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16644 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16645 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16646 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16647 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16648 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16649 keyword.
16650
16651table_trackers(<table>)
16652 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16653 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16654 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16655 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16656 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16657 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16658 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16659 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16660 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16661 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16662
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016663ub64dec
16664 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16665 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16666 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16667
16668 Example:
16669 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16670 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16671
16672ub64enc
16673 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16674
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016675upper
16676 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16677 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16678 type. The result is of type string.
16679
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016680url_dec([<in_form>])
16681 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16682 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16683 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16684 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16685 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16686 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016687
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016688url_enc([<enc_type>])
16689 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16690 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16691 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16692 optional argument is here for future changes.
16693
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016694ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016695 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016696 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16697 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16698 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016699 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16700 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16701 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16702 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016703 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016704 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16705 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016706
16707 Example:
16708 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16709 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16710
16711 message Point {
16712 int32 latitude = 1;
16713 int32 longitude = 2;
16714 }
16715
16716 message PPoint {
16717 Point point = 59;
16718 }
16719
16720 message Rectangle {
16721 // One corner of the rectangle.
16722 PPoint lo = 48;
16723 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16724 PPoint hi = 49;
16725 }
16726
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016727 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16728 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16729 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016730
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016731 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16732 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016733 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016734 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16735
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016736 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016737
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016738 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016739
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016740 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16741 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16742 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016743
16744 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16745 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16746 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16747
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016748 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16749 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16750 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016751
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016752
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016753unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016754 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16755 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16756 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16757 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16758 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16759 response),
16760 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16761 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16762 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16763 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16764
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016765utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16766 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16767 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16768 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16769 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16770 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16771 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16772
16773 Example :
16774
16775 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016776 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016777 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16778
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016779word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16780 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16781 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16782 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016783 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016784 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16785 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16786
16787 Example :
16788 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16789 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16790 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16791 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16792 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016793 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016794
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016795wt6([<avalanche>])
16796 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16797 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16798 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16799 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16800 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16801 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16802 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016803 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16804 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016805
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016806xor(<value>)
16807 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016808 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016809 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016810 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016811 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016812 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16813 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016814 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016815 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16816 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016817 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016818 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016819
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016820xxh3([<seed>])
16821 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16822 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16823 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16824 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16825 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16826 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16827 considered as cryptographically secure.
16828
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016829xxh32([<seed>])
16830 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16831 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16832 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16833 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16834 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16835 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16836 as cryptographically secure.
16837
16838xxh64([<seed>])
16839 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16840 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16841 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16842 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16843 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16844 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16845 as cryptographically secure.
16846
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016847
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168487.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016849--------------------------------------------
16850
16851A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16852not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16853"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16854The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16855
16856always_false : boolean
16857 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16858 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16859
16860always_true : boolean
16861 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16862 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16863
16864avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016865 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016866 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16867 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16868 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16869 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16870 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16871 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16872 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16873 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16874 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16875 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16876 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16877 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16878 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016880be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016881 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16882 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16883 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16884 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016885 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16886
16887be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16888 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16889 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16890 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16891 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16892 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016893 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16894 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016895
16896 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16897 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16898 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016900be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16901 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16902 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16903 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016904 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016905 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16906 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016907
16908 Example :
16909 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16910 backend dynamic
16911 mode http
16912 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16913 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016914
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016915bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016916 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16917 of the string.
16918
16919bool(<bool>) : bool
16920 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16921 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016923connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16924 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016925 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016926 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16927 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016928
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016929 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016930 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016931 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16932
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016933 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16934 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016935
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016936 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016937 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016938 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016939 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016940 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016941 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016942 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016943
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016944 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16945 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016946 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016947 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016948
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016949cpu_calls : integer
16950 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16951 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16952 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16953 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16954 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16955 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16956
16957cpu_ns_avg : integer
16958 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16959 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16960 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16961 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16962 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16963 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16964 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16965 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16966 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16967 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16968 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16969
16970cpu_ns_tot : integer
16971 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16972 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16973 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16974 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16975 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16976 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16977 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16978 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16979 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16980 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16981 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16982 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16983 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16984
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016985date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016986 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016987
16988 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16989 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16990 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016991 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16992
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016993 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16994 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16995 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16996 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16997 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16998
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016999 Example :
17000
17001 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17002 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017003
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017004 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17005 # millisecond granularity
17006 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17007
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017008date_us : integer
17009 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17010 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17011 from the same timeval structure.
17012
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017013distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17014 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17015 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17016 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17017 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17018 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17019 list of supported tokens.
17020
17021distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17022 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17023 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17024 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17025 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17026 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17027 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17028 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17029 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17030 supported tokens.
17031
17032 Example :
17033 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17034 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17035 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17036 # send large files to the big farm
17037 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17038
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017039env(<name>) : string
17040 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17041 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17042 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17043 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17044 certain way.
17045
17046 Examples :
17047 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17048 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17049
17050 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17051 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017053fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17054 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017055 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17056 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017057 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17058 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017059 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017060 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17061 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017062
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017063fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17064 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17065 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17066 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017068fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17069 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17070 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17071 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17072 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17073 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17074 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17075 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17076 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017077
17078 Example :
17079 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17080 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17081 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17082 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17083 frontend mail
17084 bind :25
17085 mode tcp
17086 maxconn 100
17087 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17088 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17089 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17090 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017091
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017092hostname : string
17093 Returns the system hostname.
17094
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017095int(<integer>) : signed integer
17096 Returns a signed integer.
17097
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017098ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17099 Returns an ipv4.
17100
17101ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17102 Returns an ipv6.
17103
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017104lat_ns_avg : integer
17105 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17106 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17107 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17108 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17109 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17110 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17111 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17112 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17113 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017114 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17115 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17116 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17117 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17118 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17119 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017120
17121lat_ns_tot : integer
17122 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17123 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17124 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17125 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17126 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17127 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17128 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17129 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17130 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017131 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17132 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17133 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17134 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17135 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017136 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17137 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17138 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17139 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17140 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17141 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17142
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017143meth(<method>) : method
17144 Returns a method.
17145
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017146nbproc : integer
17147 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17148 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17149 and debugging purposes.
17150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017151nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17152 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17153 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17154 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017155 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17156 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17157 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017158
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017159prio_class : integer
17160 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17161 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17162 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17163
17164prio_offset : integer
17165 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17166 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17167 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17168 set-priority-offset".
17169
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017170proc : integer
17171 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17172 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17173 debugging purposes.
17174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017175queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017176 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17177 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17178 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017179 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17180 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17181 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17182 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17183 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17184
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017185rand([<range>]) : integer
17186 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17187 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17188 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17189 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17190 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17191
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017192uuid([<version>]) : string
17193 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17194 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17195 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017197srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17198 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17199 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17200 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17201 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17202 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017203 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17204 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17205
17206srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17207 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17208 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17209 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17210 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17211 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17212 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17213 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17214
17215 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17216 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017217
17218srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17219 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17220 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17221 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017222 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17224 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17225 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17226
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017227srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17228 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17229 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17230 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17231 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17232 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17233 fetch methods.
17234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017235srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17236 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17237 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017238 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017239 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17240 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017241 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017242 overloading servers).
17243
17244 Example :
17245 # Redirect to a separate back
17246 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17247 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17248 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17249
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017250srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17251 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17252 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17253 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17254
17255srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17256 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17257 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17258 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17259
17260srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17261 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17262 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17263 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17264
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017265stopping : boolean
17266 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17267 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17268 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17269
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017270str(<string>) : string
17271 Returns a string.
17272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017273table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17274 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17275 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17276
17277table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17278 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17279 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17280 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17281
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017282thread : integer
17283 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17284 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17285 and debugging purposes.
17286
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017287var(<var-name>) : undefined
17288 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017289 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17290 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017291 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017292 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17293 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017294 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017295 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17296 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017297 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017298 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017299
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173007.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017301----------------------------------
17302
17303The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17304closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17305methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17306sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17307TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017308the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17309counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017310"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17311used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17312can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17313Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17314table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17315tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17316currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017317
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017318bc_dst : ip
17319 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17320 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17321 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17322 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17323
17324bc_dst_port : integer
17325 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17326 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17327
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017328bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017329 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17330 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17331 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17332
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017333bc_src : ip
17334 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17335 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17336 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17337 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17338
17339bc_src_port : integer
17340 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17341 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017343be_id : integer
17344 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017345 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17346 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017347
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017348be_name : string
17349 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017350 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17351 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017352
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017353be_server_timeout : integer
17354 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17355 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17356 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17357
17358be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17359 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17360 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17361 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17362
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017363cur_server_timeout : integer
17364 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17365 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17366 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17367
17368cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17369 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17370 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17371 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017373dst : ip
17374 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17375 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17376 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17377 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017378 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17379 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17380 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17381 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17382 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17383 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017384
17385dst_conn : integer
17386 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17387 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17388 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17389 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17390 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17391 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17392 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17393 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017394
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017395dst_is_local : boolean
17396 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17397 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17398 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17399 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017400 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017401 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17402 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17403 it only once per connection.
17404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017405dst_port : integer
17406 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17407 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17408 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17409 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17410 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17411 an HTTP header.
17412
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017413fc_http_major : integer
17414 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17415 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17416 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17417
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017418fc_pp_authority : string
17419 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17420 if any.
17421
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017422fc_pp_unique_id : string
17423 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17424 if any.
17425
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017426fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17427 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17428 header.
17429
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017430fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17431 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17432 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17433 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17434 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17435 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17436 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17437
17438fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17439 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17440 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17441 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17442 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17443 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17444 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17445
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017446fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017447 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17448 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17449 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17450 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17451
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017452fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017453 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17454 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17455 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17456 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17457
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017458fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017459 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17460 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17461 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17462 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17463
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017464fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017465 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17466 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17467 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17468 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17469
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017470fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017471 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17472 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17473 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17474 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17475
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017476fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017477 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17478 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17479 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17480 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17481
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017482fe_defbe : string
17483 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17484 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017486fe_id : integer
17487 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017488 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017489 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17490
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017491fe_name : string
17492 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17493 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17494 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17495
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017496fe_client_timeout : integer
17497 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17498 current frontend.
17499
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017500sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017501sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17502sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17503sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017504 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17505 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17506 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17507
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017508sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017509sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17510sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17511sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017512 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17513 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17514 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17515
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017516sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017517sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17518sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17519sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017520 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17521 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017522 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17523 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17524 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017525
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017526 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017527 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17528 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017529 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17530 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17531 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017532 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17533 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17534
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017535sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17536sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17537sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17538sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17539 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17540 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17541 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17542 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17543 when a first ACL was verified.
17544
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017545sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017546sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17547sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17548sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017549 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017550 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17551
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017552sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017553sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17554sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17555sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017556 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17557 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17558 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17559
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017560sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017561sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17562sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17563sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017564 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17565 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17566 See also src_conn_rate.
17567
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017568sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017569sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17570sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17571sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017572 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017573 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017574
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017575sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17576sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17577sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17578sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17579 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17580 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17581
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017582sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17583sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17584sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17585sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17586 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17587 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17588
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017589sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017590sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17591sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17592sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017593 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17594 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17595 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017596 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17597 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17598 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017599
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017600sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17601sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17602sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17603sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17604 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17605 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17606 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17607 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17608 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17609 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17610
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017611sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017612sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17613sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17614sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017615 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017616 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17617 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17618
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017619sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017620sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17621sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17622sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017623 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17624 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17625 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17626 src_http_err_rate.
17627
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017628sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17629sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17630sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17631sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17632 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17633 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17634 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17635
17636sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17637sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17638sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17639sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17640 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17641 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17642 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17643 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17644
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017645sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017646sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17647sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17648sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017649 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017650 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17651 src_http_req_cnt.
17652
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017653sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017654sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17655sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17656sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017657 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17658 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17659 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17660 src_http_req_rate.
17661
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017662sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017663sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17664sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17665sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017666 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017667 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17668 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17669 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17670 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017671
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017672 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017673 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17674 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017675 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17676
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017677sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17678sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17679sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17680sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17681 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17682 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17683 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17684 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17685 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17686
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017687sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017688sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17689sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17690sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017691 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17692 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17693 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017694
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017695sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017696sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17697sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17698sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017699 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17700 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17701 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017702
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017703sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017704sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17705sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17706sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017707 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017708 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17709 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17710 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017711 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017712 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17713
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017714sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017715sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17716sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17717sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017718 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17719 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17720 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17721 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17722 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017723 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017724
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017725sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017726sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17727sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17728sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017729 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17730 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17731 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17732
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017733sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017734sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17735sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17736sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017737 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17738 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017739 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017740 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17741 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017742 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17743 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17744 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017746so_id : integer
17747 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17748 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17749 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017750
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017751so_name : string
17752 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17753 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17754 strings instead of integers.
17755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017756src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017757 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017758 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17759 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17760 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017761 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17762 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17763 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017764 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17765 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17766 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17767 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17768 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17769 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17770 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017771
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017772 Example:
17773 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17774 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017776src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17777 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17778 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17779 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017780 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17783 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17784 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017785 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017786 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017788src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17789 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17790 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17791 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17792 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17793 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17794 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017795
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017796 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017797 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17798 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17799 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17800 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017801 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017802 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17803 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17804
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017805src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17806 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17807 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17808 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17809 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17810 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17811 was verified.
17812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017813src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017814 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017815 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017816 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017817 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017819src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017820 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017821 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17822 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017823 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017825src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17826 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17827 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17828 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017829 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017831src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017832 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017833 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017834 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017835 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017836
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017837src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17838 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17839 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17840 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17841 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17842
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017843src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17844 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17845 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17846 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17847 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017849src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017850 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017851 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017852 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17853 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017854 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17855 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17856 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017857
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017858src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17859 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17860 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17861 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17862 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17863 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17864 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17865 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017867src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017868 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017869 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017870 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017871 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017872 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017874src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17875 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17876 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17877 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17878 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017879 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017880
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017881src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17882 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17883 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050017884 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017885 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17886 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17887
17888src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17889 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17890 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17891 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17892 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17893 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17894 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017896src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017897 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017898 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17899 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017900 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017902src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17903 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17904 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17905 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017906 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017907 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017909src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17910 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17911 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17912 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017913 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017914 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17915 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017916
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017917 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017918 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017919 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017920 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017921
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017922src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17923 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17924 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17925 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17926 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17927 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17928 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17929
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017930src_is_local : boolean
17931 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17932 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17933 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17934 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017935 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017936 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17937 once per connection.
17938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017939src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017940 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17941 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17942 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17943 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17944 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017946src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017947 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17948 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17949 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17950 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17951 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017953src_port : integer
17954 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17955 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17956 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17957 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017959src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017960 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017961 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17962 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17963 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017964 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017966src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17967 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17968 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17969 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17970 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017971 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017973src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17974 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17975 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17976 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17977 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17978 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17979 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17980 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17981 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017982
17983 Example :
17984 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17985 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17986 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17987 listen ssh
17988 bind :22
17989 mode tcp
17990 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017991 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017992 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017993 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017995srv_id : integer
17996 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17997 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017998 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017999
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018000srv_name : string
18001 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18002 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018003 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018004
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180057.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018006----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018008The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18009closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18010when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18011usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018012future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018013
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001801451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18015 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18016 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18017 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18018 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18019 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18020
18021 Example :
18022 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18023 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18024 # the request.
18025 frontend http-in
18026 bind *:8081
18027 default_backend servers
18028 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18029 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18030
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018031ssl_bc : boolean
18032 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18033 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018034 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18035 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018036
18037ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18038 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018039 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18040 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018041
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018042ssl_bc_alpn : string
18043 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18044 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018045 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018046 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18047 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18048 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18049 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18050 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018051 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18052 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018053
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018054ssl_bc_cipher : string
18055 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018056 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18057 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018058
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018059ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18060 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18061 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18062 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018063 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018064
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018065ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18066 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18067 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018068 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18069 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018070
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018071ssl_bc_npn : string
18072 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18073 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018074 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018075 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18076 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18077 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18078 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018079 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18080 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018081
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018082ssl_bc_protocol : string
18083 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018084 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18085 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018086
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018087ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018088 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018089 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018090 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18091 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018092
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018093ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18094 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18095 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18096 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018097 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018098
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018099ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18100 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18101 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018102 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18103 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018104
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018105ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18106 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18107 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18108 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018109 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018110
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018111ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18112 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018113 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18114 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018116ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18117 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18118 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18119 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18120 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18121 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018123ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18124 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18125 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18126 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18127 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018128
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018129ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018130 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18131 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18132 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018133 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018134 does not support resumed sessions.
18135
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018136ssl_c_der : binary
18137 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18138 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18139 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018141ssl_c_err : integer
18142 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18143 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18144 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18145 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18146 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018147
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018148ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018149 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18150 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18151 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18152 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18153 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18154 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18155 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18156 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018157 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18158 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18159 LDAP v3.
18160 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18161 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018163ssl_c_key_alg : string
18164 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18165 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18166 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018168ssl_c_notafter : string
18169 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18170 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18171 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018173ssl_c_notbefore : string
18174 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18175 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18176 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018177
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018178ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018179 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18180 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18181 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18182 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18183 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18184 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18185 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18186 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018187 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18188 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18189 LDAP v3.
18190 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18191 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018193ssl_c_serial : binary
18194 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18195 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18196 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018198ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18199 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18200 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18201 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018202 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18203 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18204
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018205 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018206 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018208ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18209 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18210 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18211 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018213ssl_c_used : boolean
18214 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18215 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018217ssl_c_verify : integer
18218 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18219 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18220 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18221 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018223ssl_c_version : integer
18224 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18225 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018226
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018227ssl_f_der : binary
18228 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18229 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18230 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18231
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018232ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018233 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18234 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18235 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18236 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018237 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018238 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18239 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18240 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018241 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18242 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18243 LDAP v3.
18244 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18245 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018247ssl_f_key_alg : string
18248 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18249 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18250 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018252ssl_f_notafter : string
18253 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18254 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18255 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018257ssl_f_notbefore : string
18258 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18259 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18260 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018261
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018262ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018263 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18264 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18265 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18266 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18267 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18268 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18269 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18270 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018271 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18272 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18273 LDAP v3.
18274 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18275 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018277ssl_f_serial : binary
18278 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18279 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18280 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018281
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018282ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18283 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18284 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18285 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018287ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18288 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18289 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18290 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018292ssl_f_version : integer
18293 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18294 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18295
18296ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018297 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18298 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18299 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018301 Example :
18302 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18303 listen http-https
18304 bind :80
18305 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18306 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18307
18308ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18309 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18310 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18311
18312ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018313 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018314 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18315 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18316 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18317 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18318 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18319 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18320 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18321 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018323ssl_fc_cipher : string
18324 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18325 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018326
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018327ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18328 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18329 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018330 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018331
18332ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18333 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18334 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018335 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018336
18337ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18338 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18339 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18340 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018341 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018342 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018343
18344ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18345 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18346 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018347 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018348
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018349ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18350 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18351 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18352 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18353
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018354ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18355 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18356 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18357 transport layer.
18358 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18359 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18360 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18361 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18362
18363ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18364 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18365 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18366 transport layer.
18367 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18368 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18369 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18370 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18371
18372ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18373 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18374 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18375 transport layer.
18376 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18377 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18378 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18379 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18380
18381ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18382 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18383 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18384 transport layer.
18385 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18386 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18387 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18388 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18389
18390ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18391 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18392 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18393 transport layer.
18394 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18395 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18396 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18397 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018399ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018400 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18401 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018402 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18403 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18404 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18405 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018406
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018407ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18408 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18409 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18410 wait until the handshake happened.
18411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018412ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18413 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018414 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18415 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018416 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018417 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018418
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018419ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018420 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018421 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18422 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018424ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018425 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018426 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18427 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18428 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18429 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18430 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18431 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18432 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018434ssl_fc_protocol : string
18435 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18436 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018437
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018438ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018439 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018440 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18441 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018442
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018443ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18444 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18445 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18446 transport layer.
18447 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18448 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18449 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18450 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18451
18452ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18453 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18454 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18455 transport layer.
18456 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18457 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18458 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18459 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18460
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018461ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18462 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18463 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18464 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018466ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18467 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18468 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18469 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18470 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018471
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018472ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18473 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18474 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18475 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18476 BoringSSL.
18477
18478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018479ssl_fc_sni : string
18480 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18481 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18482 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18483 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18484 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18485
18486 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18487 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18488 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018489 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018490 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018492 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018493 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18494 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018496ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18497 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18498 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018499
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018500ssl_s_der : binary
18501 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18502 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18503 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18504
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018505ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18506 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18507 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18508 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018509 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018510 does not support resumed sessions.
18511
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018512ssl_s_key_alg : string
18513 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18514 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18515 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18516
18517ssl_s_notafter : string
18518 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18519 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18520 transport layer.
18521
18522ssl_s_notbefore : string
18523 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18524 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18525 transport layer.
18526
18527ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18528 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18529 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18530 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18531 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18532 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18533 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018534 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18535 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018536 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18537 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18538 LDAP v3.
18539 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18540 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18541
18542ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18543 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18544 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18545 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18546 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18547 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18548 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018549 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18550 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018551 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18552 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18553 LDAP v3.
18554 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18555 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18556
18557ssl_s_serial : binary
18558 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18559 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18560 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18561
18562ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18563 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18564 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18565 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18566
18567ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18568 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18569 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18570 layer.
18571
18572ssl_s_version : integer
18573 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18574 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018575
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018577------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018579Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18580sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18581only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18582For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18583be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18584can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18585sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18586for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18587content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018588
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018589Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18590 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18591 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18592 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18593 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18594 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18595 sample expression). So be careful.
18596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018597payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018598 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018599 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18600 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018602payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18603 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018604 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018605 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018607req.len : integer
18608req_len : integer (deprecated)
18609 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18610 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18611 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18612 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18613 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18614 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18615 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18616 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018618req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18619 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018620 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18621 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18622 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18623 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018625 ACL alternatives :
18626 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018628req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18629 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18630 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18631 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18632 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018634 ACL alternatives :
18635 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018637 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018639req.proto_http : boolean
18640req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18641 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18642 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18643 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18644 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18645 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18646 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18647 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018649 Example:
18650 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18651 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18652 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018653 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018655req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18656rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18657 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18658 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18659 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18660 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18661 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18662 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18663 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18666 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18667 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18668 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18669 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18670 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018672 ACL derivatives :
18673 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018675 Example :
18676 listen tse-farm
18677 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18678 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18679 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18680 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18681 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18682 persist rdp-cookie
18683 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18684 # This is only useful makes sense if
18685 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18686 stick-table type string size 204800
18687 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18688 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18689 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018691 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18692 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018694req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18695rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18696 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18697 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18698 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18699 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018701 ACL derivatives :
18702 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018703
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018704req.ssl_alpn : string
18705 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18706 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18707 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18708 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18709 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18710 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018711 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018712
18713 Examples :
18714 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18715 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18716 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018717 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018718 default_backend bk_default
18719
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018720req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18721 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18722 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018723 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18724 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18725 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18726 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18727 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18730req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18731 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18732 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18733 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18734 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18735 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18736 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18737 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018739req.ssl_sni : string
18740req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18741 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18742 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18743 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18744 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18745 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018746 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18747 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18748 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18749 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18750 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18751 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18752 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18753 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18754 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018756 ACL derivatives :
18757 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018759 Examples :
18760 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18761 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18762 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18763 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18764 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018765
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018766req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18767 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18768 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18769 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18770 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18771 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18772 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18773 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18774 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18775 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018777req.ssl_ver : integer
18778req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18779 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18780 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18781 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18782 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18783 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18784 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18785 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018786 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018787 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018789 ACL derivatives :
18790 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018791
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018792res.len : integer
18793 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18794 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18795 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18796 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18797 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18798 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18799 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018800 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018802res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18803 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018804 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018805 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018806 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018807 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018809res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18810 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18811 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18812 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018813 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18814 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018816 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018817
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018818res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18819rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18820 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18821 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18822 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18823 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18824 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18825 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18826 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018828wait_end : boolean
18829 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18830 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018831 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018832 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18833 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018834 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018835 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18836 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018838 Examples :
18839 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18840 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18841 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18844 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18845 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18846 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18847 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18848 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18849 tcp-request content reject
18850
18851
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188527.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018853--------------------------------------
18854
18855It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18856This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18857data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18858its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18859HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18860content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18861to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18862more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18863response are indexed.
18864
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010018865Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
18866 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
18867 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
18868 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
18869 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
18870 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
18871 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
18872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018873base : string
18874 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18875 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18876 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18877 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18878 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18879 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18880 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18881 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18882
18883 ACL derivatives :
18884 base : exact string match
18885 base_beg : prefix match
18886 base_dir : subdir match
18887 base_dom : domain match
18888 base_end : suffix match
18889 base_len : length match
18890 base_reg : regex match
18891 base_sub : substring match
18892
18893base32 : integer
18894 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18895 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18896 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018897 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18898 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18899 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018900
18901base32+src : binary
18902 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18903 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18904 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18905 per-URL counters.
18906
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010018907baseq : string
18908 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18909 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
18910 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
18911 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
18912
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018913capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18914 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18915 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18916 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18917
18918capture.req.method : string
18919 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18920 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18921 because it's allocated.
18922
18923capture.req.uri : string
18924 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18925 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18926 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18927 allocated.
18928
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018929capture.req.ver : string
18930 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18931 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18932 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18933
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018934capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18935 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18936 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18937 The first entry is an index of 0.
18938 See also: "capture response header"
18939
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018940capture.res.ver : string
18941 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18942 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18943 persistent flag.
18944
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018945req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018946 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18947 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18948 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018949
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018950req.body_param([<name>) : string
18951 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18952 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18953 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18954 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18955 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18956 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18957 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18958 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18959 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18960 given.
18961
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018962req.body_len : integer
18963 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18964 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018965 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18966 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018967
18968req.body_size : integer
18969 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018970 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18971 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018973req.cook([<name>]) : string
18974cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18975 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18976 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18977 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18978 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18979 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18980 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18981 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18982 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18983
18984 ACL derivatives :
18985 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18986 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18987 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18988 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18989 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18990 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18991 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18992 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018994req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18995cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18996 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18997 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018999req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19000cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19001 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19002 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19003 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19004 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019006cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19007 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19008 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19009 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19010 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019011 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019012 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19013 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19014 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19015 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019017hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19018 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19019 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19020 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19021 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019022 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019024req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019025 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19026 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19027 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19028 with headers such as User-Agent.
19029
19030 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19031 found.
19032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019033 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19034 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19035 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019036 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019038req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19039 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19040 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019041 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19042 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019044req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019045 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19046 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19047 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19048 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19049 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19050 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19051 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19052
19053 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19054 found.
19055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019056 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19057 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19058 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019059 with -1 being the last one.
19060
19061 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19062 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019064 ACL derivatives :
19065 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19066 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19067 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19068 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19069 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19070 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19071 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19072 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19073
19074req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19075hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19076 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19077 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019078 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19079 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19080 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19081
19082 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19083 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19084 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19085
19086 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019087
19088req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19089hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19090 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19091 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19092 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019093 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19094 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19095 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19096 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19097 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019098
19099 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19100
19101 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019102
19103req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19104hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19105 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19106 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19107 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019108
19109 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19110
19111 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019112
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019113req.hdrs : string
19114 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19115 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19116 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19117 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19118
19119req.hdrs_bin : binary
19120 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19121 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19122 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19123 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19124 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19125 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19126
19127 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019128
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019129 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19130 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019132http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19133 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19134 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19135 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19136 basic auth is supported.
19137
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019138http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19139 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19140 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19141 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19142 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19144 basic auth is supported.
19145
19146 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019147 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19148 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19149 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19150 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019151
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019152http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019153 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19154 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19155 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019156
19157http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019158 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19159 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19160 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019161
19162http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019163 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19164 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19165 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019167http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019168 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19169 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019170 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19171 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019173method : integer + string
19174 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19175 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19176 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19177 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19178 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19179 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19180 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019182 ACL derivatives :
19183 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019185 Example :
19186 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19187 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19188 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019190path : string
19191 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19192 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19193 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19194 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19195 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019196 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019197 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019199 ACL derivatives :
19200 path : exact string match
19201 path_beg : prefix match
19202 path_dir : subdir match
19203 path_dom : domain match
19204 path_end : suffix match
19205 path_len : length match
19206 path_reg : regex match
19207 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019208
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019209pathq : string
19210 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19211 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19212 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19213 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19214 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19215 result in both cases.
19216
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019217query : string
19218 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19219 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19220 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19221 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019222 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019223 which stops before the question mark.
19224
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019225req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19226 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19227 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19228 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19229 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019231req.ver : string
19232req_ver : string (deprecated)
19233 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19234 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19235 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019237 ACL derivatives :
19238 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019239
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019240res.body : binary
19241 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19242 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019243 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19244
19245 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019246
19247res.body_len : integer
19248 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19249 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019250 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19251
19252 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019253
19254res.body_size : integer
19255 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19256 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19257 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19258 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019259 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19260
19261 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019262
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019263res.cache_hit : boolean
19264 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19265 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19266
19267res.cache_name : string
19268 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19269 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19270 empty string.
19271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019272res.comp : boolean
19273 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19274 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19275 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019277res.comp_algo : string
19278 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19279 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19280 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019282res.cook([<name>]) : string
19283scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19284 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19285 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019286 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19287
19288 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019290 ACL derivatives :
19291 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019293res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19294scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19295 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19296 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019297 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19298
19299 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019301res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19302scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19303 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19304 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019305 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19306
19307 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019309res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019310 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19311 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19312
19313 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19314 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19315
19316 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19317
19318 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019320res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019321 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19322 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19323
19324 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19325 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19326
19327 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019329res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19330shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019331 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19332 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19333
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019334 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019335 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19336
19337 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019339 ACL derivatives :
19340 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19341 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19342 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19343 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19344 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19345 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19346 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19347 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19348
19349res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19350shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019351 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19352 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19353
19354 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019355 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019356
19357 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019359res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19360shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019361 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19362 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19363
19364 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19365
19366 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019367
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019368res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19369 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19370 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19371 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019372 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19373
19374 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019376res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19377shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019378 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19379 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19380
19381 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19382
19383 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019384
19385res.hdrs : string
19386 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19387 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19388 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019389 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19390
19391 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019392
19393res.hdrs_bin : binary
19394 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19395 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19396 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19397 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19398 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19399 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19400 (length of 0 for both).
19401
19402 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19403
19404 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19405 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019407res.ver : string
19408resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19409 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019410 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19411
19412 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019414 ACL derivatives :
19415 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019417set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19418 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19419 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019420 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019421 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019423 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19424 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019426status : integer
19427 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19428 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019429 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19430
19431 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019432
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019433unique-id : string
19434 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19435 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19436 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19437 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19438 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19439 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019441url : string
19442 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19443 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19444 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19445 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19446 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19447 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19448 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019450 ACL derivatives :
19451 url : exact string match
19452 url_beg : prefix match
19453 url_dir : subdir match
19454 url_dom : domain match
19455 url_end : suffix match
19456 url_len : length match
19457 url_reg : regex match
19458 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019460url_ip : ip
19461 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19462 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19463 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19464 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19465 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19466 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19467 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019469url_port : integer
19470 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19471 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19472 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19473 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019474
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019475urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19476url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019477 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19478 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019479 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19480 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19481 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19482 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019483 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19484 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019485 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19486 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019488 ACL derivatives :
19489 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19490 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19491 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19492 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19493 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19494 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19495 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19496 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019497
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019499 Example :
19500 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19501 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19502 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19503 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019504
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019505urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019506 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19507 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19508 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019509
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019510url32 : integer
19511 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19512 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19513 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19514 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19515 is an unsigned integer.
19516
19517url32+src : binary
19518 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19519 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19520 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19521
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019522
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200195237.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019524---------------------------------------
19525
19526This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19527used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19528purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19529There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19530or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19531any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19532for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19533
19534internal.htx.data : integer
19535 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19536 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19537
19538internal.htx.free : integer
19539 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19540 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19541
19542internal.htx.free_data : integer
19543 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19544 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19545
19546internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019547 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19548 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19549 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019550
19551internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19552 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19553 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19554
19555internal.htx.size : integer
19556 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19557 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19558
19559internal.htx.used : integer
19560 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19561 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19562 direction.
19563
19564internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19565 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19566 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19567 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19568 of the special value :
19569 * head : The oldest inserted block
19570 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019571 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019572
19573internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19574 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19575 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19576 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19577 integer or one of the special value :
19578 * head : The oldest inserted block
19579 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019580 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019581
19582internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19583 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19584 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19585 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19586 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19587
19588 * head : The oldest inserted block
19589 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019590 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019591
19592internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19593 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19594 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19595 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19596 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19597
19598 * head : The oldest inserted block
19599 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019600 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019601
19602internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19603 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19604 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19605 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19606 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19607
19608 * head : The oldest inserted block
19609 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019610 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019611
19612internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19613 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19614 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19615 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19616 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19617
19618 * head : The oldest inserted block
19619 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019620 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019621
19622internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19623 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19624 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19625 it returns false.
19626
19627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200196287.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019629---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019631Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19632every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019633order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019635ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019636---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19637FALSE always_false never match
19638HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19639HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19640HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019641HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019642HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19643HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19644HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19645HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19646LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19647METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19648METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19649METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19650METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19651METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19652METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19653METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19654METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19655RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19656REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19657TRUE always_true always match
19658WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19659---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019660
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196628. Logging
19663----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019664
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019665One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19666provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19667very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19668provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19669state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019670to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019671headers.
19672
19673In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19674about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19675send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19676
19677 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19678 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19679 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19680 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19681 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019682 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019683 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019684
19685The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19686allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19687as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19688while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19689real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19690delay.
19691
19692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196938.1. Log levels
19694---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019695
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019696TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019697source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019698HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19699in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19700track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19701syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19702about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019703
19704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197058.2. Log formats
19706----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019707
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019708HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019709and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19710slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19711options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019712
19713 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19714 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19715 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19716 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19717 extents.
19718
19719 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19720 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19721 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19722 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19723 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19724
19725 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19726 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19727 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19728 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19729 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19730
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019731 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19732 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19733 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19734 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19735
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019736 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19737
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019738Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19739specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19740field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19741servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19742always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19743identifier.
19744
19745Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19746 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19747 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19748 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19749 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19750
19751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197528.2.1. Default log format
19753-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019754
19755This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19756as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19757format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19758
19759 Example :
19760 listen www
19761 mode http
19762 log global
19763 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19764
19765 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19766 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19767 (www/HTTP)
19768
19769 Field Format Extract from the example above
19770 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19771 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19772 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19773 4 'to' to
19774 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19775 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19776
19777Detailed fields description :
19778 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19779 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19780 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19781 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19782 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19783 and processed the connection.
19784 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19785
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019786In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19787"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19788connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19789
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019790It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19791will eventually disappear.
19792
19793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197948.2.2. TCP log format
19795---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019796
19797The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19798is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19799information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19800counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19801emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19802environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19803the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19804sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019805specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19806not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19807fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19808marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019809
19810 Example :
19811 frontend fnt
19812 mode tcp
19813 option tcplog
19814 log global
19815 default_backend bck
19816
19817 backend bck
19818 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19819
19820 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19821 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19822 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19823
19824 Field Format Extract from the example above
19825 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19826 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19827 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19828 4 frontend_name fnt
19829 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19830 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19831 7 bytes_read* 212
19832 8 termination_state --
19833 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19834 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19835
19836Detailed fields description :
19837 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019838 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19839 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19840 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019841 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019842 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019843 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019844
19845 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019846 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19847 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19848 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019849
19850 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19851 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19852 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019853 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19854 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19855 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19856 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019857
19858 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19859 and processed the connection.
19860
19861 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19862 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19863 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19864 applications.
19865
19866 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19867 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19868 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19869 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19870 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19871
19872 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19873 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19874 See "Timers" below for more details.
19875
19876 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19877 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19878 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19879 "Timers" below for more details.
19880
19881 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019882 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019883 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19884 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19885 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19886 details.
19887
19888 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19889 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19890 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19891 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19892 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19893
19894 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19895 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19896 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19897 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19898 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19899 for more details.
19900
19901 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019902 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019903 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19904 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19905 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019906 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019907
19908 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19909 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19910 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19911 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19912 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19913 caused by a denial of service attack.
19914
19915 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19916 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19917 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19918 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19919 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19920 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19921 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19922 denial of service attack.
19923
19924 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19925 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19926 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19927 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19928 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19929 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19930 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19931 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19932 be processed than on other servers.
19933
19934 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19935 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19936 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19937 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19938 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19939 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19940 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19941 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19942 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19943 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19944 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19945 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19946 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19947
19948 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19949 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19950 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19951 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19952 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19953 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019954 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019955 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19956
19957 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19958 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19959 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19960 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19961 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19962 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019963 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019964 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19965 occurs.
19966
19967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199688.2.3. HTTP log format
19969----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019970
19971The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19972is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19973the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19974are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19975emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19976generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19977"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19978which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019979frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19980is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019981
19982Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19983slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19984with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19985
19986 Example :
19987 frontend http-in
19988 mode http
19989 option httplog
19990 log global
19991 default_backend bck
19992
19993 backend static
19994 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19995
19996 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19997 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19998 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019999 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020000
20001 Field Format Extract from the example above
20002 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20003 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020004 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020005 4 frontend_name http-in
20006 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020007 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020008 7 status_code 200
20009 8 bytes_read* 2750
20010 9 captured_request_cookie -
20011 10 captured_response_cookie -
20012 11 termination_state ----
20013 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20014 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20015 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20016 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20017 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020018
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020019Detailed fields description :
20020 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020021 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20022 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20023 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020024 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020025 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020026 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020027
20028 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020029 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20030 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20031 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020032
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020033 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20034 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020035
20036 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20037 and processed the connection.
20038
20039 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20040 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20041 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20042
20043 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20044 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20045 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20046 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20047 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20048 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20049
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020050 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20051 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20052 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020053 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020054 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20055 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020056 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20057 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020058
20059 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20060 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020061 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020062
20063 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20064 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020065 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20066 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020067
20068 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20069 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20070 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20071 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20072 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020073 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20074 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020075
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020076 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20077 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20078 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20079 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20080 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20081 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20082 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020083 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020084
20085 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20086 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20087 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20088
20089 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20090 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020091 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020092 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20093 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20094 overflowing.
20095
20096 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20097 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20098 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20099 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20100 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20101 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20102 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20103 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20104
20105 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20106 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20107 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20108 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20109 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20110 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20111 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20112 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20113
20114 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20115 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20116 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20117 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20118 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20119 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20120 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20121
20122 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020123 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020124 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20125 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20126 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020127 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020128 system.
20129
20130 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20131 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20132 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20133 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20134 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20135 caused by a denial of service attack.
20136
20137 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20138 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20139 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20140 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20141 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20142 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20143 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20144 denial of service attack.
20145
20146 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20147 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20148 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20149 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20150 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20151 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20152 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20153 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20154 processed than on other servers.
20155
20156 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20157 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20158 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20159 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20160 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20161 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20162 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20163 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20164 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20165 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20166 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20167 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20168 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20169
20170 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20171 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20172 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20173 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20174 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20175 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020176 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020177 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20178
20179 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20180 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20181 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20182 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20183 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20184 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020185 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020186 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20187 occurs.
20188
20189 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20190 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20191 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20192 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20193 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20194 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20195 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20196 cookies" below for more details.
20197
20198 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20199 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20200 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20201 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20202 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20203 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20204 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20205 and cookies" below for more details.
20206
20207 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20208 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20209 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20210 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20211 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20212 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20213 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20214 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20215
20216
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200202178.2.4. Custom log format
20218------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020219
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020220The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020221mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020222
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020223HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020224Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20225separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20226prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20227
20228Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20229variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020230("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020231
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020232If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020233as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020234less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20235the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20236
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020237Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20238"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20239delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20240preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020241
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020242Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20243'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20244https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20245such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20246
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020247Flags are :
20248 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020249 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020250 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20251 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020252
20253 Example:
20254
20255 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20256 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20257
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020258 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20259
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020260At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20261
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020262 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20263 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020264
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020265the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020266
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020267 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20268 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20269 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020270
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020271and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20272
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020273 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20274 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020275
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020276Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20277
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020278 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020279 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020280 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20281 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20282 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020283 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20284 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20285 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020286 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020287 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020288 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020289 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020290 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020291 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20292 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020293 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020294 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020295 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020296 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020297 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020298 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020299 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020300 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20301 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20302 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20303 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20304 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020305 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020306 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020307 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020308 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020309 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020310 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20311 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020312 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20313 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20314 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020315 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020316 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20317 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020318 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020319 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20320 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20321 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020322 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020323 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020324 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20325 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20326 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20327 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020328 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020329 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020330 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020331 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020332 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020333 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020334 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20335 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20336 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020337 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020338 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20339 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020340 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020341 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20342 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020343 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020344 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020345 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020346 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020347
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020348 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020349
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020350
203518.2.5. Error log format
20352-----------------------
20353
20354When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20355protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20356By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20357"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020358will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020359logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20360
20361The format looks like this :
20362
20363 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20364 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20365 Connection error during SSL handshake
20366
20367 Field Format Extract from the example above
20368 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20369 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20370 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20371 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20372 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20373
20374These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20375failures.
20376
20377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203788.3. Advanced logging options
20379-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020380
20381Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20382just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20383options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20384for more information about their usage.
20385
20386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203878.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20388------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020389
20390It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20391haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20392commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20393monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20394ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20395
20396 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20397 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20398 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20399 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20400
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020401 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20402 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020403
20404 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20405 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20406 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20407
20408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204098.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20410----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020411
20412The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20413what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20414or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020415"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020416just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20417log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20418after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20419is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20420with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20421with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20422
20423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204248.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20425------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020426
20427Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20428for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20429"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20430retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20431raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20432a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20433file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20434you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20435"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20436
20437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204388.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20439--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020440
20441Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20442multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20443them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20444"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20445logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20446error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20447and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20448too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20449useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20450alternative.
20451
20452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204538.4. Timing events
20454------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020455
20456Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20457reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20458the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20459frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020460mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20461addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20462
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020463Timings events in HTTP mode:
20464
20465 first request 2nd request
20466 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20467 t tr t tr ...
20468 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20469 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20470 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20471 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020472 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020473 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20474
20475Timings events in TCP mode:
20476
20477 TCP session
20478 |<----------------->|
20479 t t
20480 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20481 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20482 |<------ Tt ------->|
20483
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020484 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020485 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020486 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20487 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20488 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020489 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020490 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20491 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20492 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20493 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020494
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020495 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20496 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20497 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020498 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20499 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20500 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20501 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20502 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20503 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020504
20505 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20506 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20507 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20508 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20509 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20510 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20511 request typed by hand during a test.
20512
20513 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20514 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020515 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020516 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20517 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20518 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20519 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020520
20521 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20522 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20523 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20524 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20525 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20526
20527 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20528 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20529 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20530 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20531 connection never established.
20532
20533 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20534 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20535 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20536 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20537 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20538 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20539 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20540 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20541 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20542 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20543 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20544
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020545 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20546 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20547 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20548 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20549 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20550 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20551
20552 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20553
20554 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20555 "Ta" can never be negative.
20556
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020557 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20558 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020559 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20560 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020561 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020562
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020563 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020564
20565 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020566 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20567 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020568
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020569 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20570 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20571 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20572 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20573 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20574 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20575 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20576 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20577
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020578These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20579protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20580that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020581due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20582"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20583that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020584
20585Most common cases :
20586
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020587 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20588 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20589 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20590 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20591 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20592 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20593 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20594 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20595 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20596 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20597 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020598 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020599
20600 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20601 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20602 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20603 of ms on remote networks.
20604
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020605 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20606 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20607 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020608
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020609 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20610 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20611 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20612 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20613 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20614 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20615 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20616 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20617 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020618
20619Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20620
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020621 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020622 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020623 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020624
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020625 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020626 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20627 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20628
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020629 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020630 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20631 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20632 flags.
20633
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020634 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20635 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020636 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20637 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20638 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20639 the client connection was maintained open.
20640
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020641 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020642 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020643 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020644 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20645
20646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206478.5. Session state at disconnection
20648-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020649
20650TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20651"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
206522-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20653each of which has a special meaning :
20654
20655 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20656 session to terminate :
20657
20658 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20659
20660 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20661 server explicitly refused it.
20662
20663 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20664 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20665 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20666 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020667 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020668
20669 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20670 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020671
20672 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20673 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20674 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20675 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20676 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20677
20678 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20679 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20680 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20681 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20682 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20683
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020684 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20685 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20686
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020687 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20688 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20689 backup connections when going up.
20690
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020691 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20692
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020693 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20694 send or receive data.
20695
20696 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20697 send or receive data.
20698
20699 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20700 with nothing left in the buffers.
20701
20702 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20703
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020704 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020705 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20706
20707 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20708 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20709 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20710 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20711 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20712
20713 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20714 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20715
20716 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20717 server (HTTP only).
20718
20719 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20720
20721 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20722 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20723 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20724
20725 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20726 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20727 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20728
20729 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20730
20731 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20732 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20733
20734 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20735 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20736 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20737
20738 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20739 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020740 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20741 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020742
20743 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20744 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20745 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20746 another server.
20747
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020748 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020749 server.
20750
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020751 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20752 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20753 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20754 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20755
20756 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20757 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20758 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20759 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20760
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020761 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20762 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20763 "use-server" rule).
20764
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020765 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20766
20767 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20768 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20769
20770 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20771
20772 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20773 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20774 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20775
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020776 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20777 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020778 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020779 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20780 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20781
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020782 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20783
20784 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20785 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20786
20787 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20788
20789 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20790
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020791The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20792was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020793helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20794starvation, attacks, etc...
20795
20796The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20797alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20798easier finding and understanding.
20799
20800 Flags Reason
20801
20802 -- Normal termination.
20803
20804 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20805 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20806 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20807 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20808
20809 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20810 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20811 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20812 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20813 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20814 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020815
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020816 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20817 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020818 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020819
20820 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20821 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20822 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20823
20824 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20825 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20826 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20827 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20828 the server takes too long to respond.
20829
20830 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20831 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20832 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20833 long a time to respond.
20834
20835 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20836 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20837 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20838 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020839 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20840 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020841
20842 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20843 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20844 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20845 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20846 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020847 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020848 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20849 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20850 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20851 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20852 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20853 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20854 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20855 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020856 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020857 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20858 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20859 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020860
20861 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20862 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020863 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20864 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20865 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20866 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020867
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020868 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20869 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020871 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020872 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20873 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020874 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020875 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20876 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20877
20878 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20879 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20880 503 or 504 here.
20881
20882 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20883 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20884 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20885 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20886 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20887
20888 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20889 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020890 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020891 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20892 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20893
20894 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20895 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20896 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20897 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20898 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20899 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20900 between haproxy and the server.
20901
20902 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20903 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20904 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20905 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20906 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20907 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20908 solution is to fix the application.
20909
20910 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20911 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20912 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20913 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20914 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20915 external attacks.
20916
20917 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020918 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020919 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020920 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20921 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20922
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020923 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20924 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20925 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020926 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020927 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020928
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020929 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20930 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20931 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20932 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020933 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20934 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20935 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20936 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20937 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020938
20939 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20940 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20941 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20942 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20943
20944 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20945 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20946 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20947 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20948
20949 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20950 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20951 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20952 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20953
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020954The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20955persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20956important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20957re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20958
20959 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20960
20961 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20962 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20963 set on a GET request.
20964
20965 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20966 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020967 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020968 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20969
20970 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20971 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20972 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20973
20974 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20975 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20976 already got a cookie.
20977
20978 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20979 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20980 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20981 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20982 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20983
20984 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20985 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20986 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20987
20988 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20989 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20990 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20991
20992 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20993 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20994
20995 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20996 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20997 then advertised in the response.
20998
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210008.6. Non-printable characters
21001-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021002
21003In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21004consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21005converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21006prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21007being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21008escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21009is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21010'}' when logging headers.
21011
21012Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21013issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21014containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21015
21016Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21017the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21018performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21019
21020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210218.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21022---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021023
21024Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21025achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021026section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021027cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21028the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21029the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021030locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021031not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21032user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21033a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21034wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21035
21036 Examples :
21037 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21038 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21039
21040 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21041 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21042
21043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210448.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21045---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021046
21047Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21048proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21049the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21050server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21051
21052Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21053response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021054section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021055
21056It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021057time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21058appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021059are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21060and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21061follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21062request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21063in the logs.
21064
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021065As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21066frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21067an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21068
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021069 Example :
21070 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21071 listen proxy-out
21072 mode http
21073 option httplog
21074 option logasap
21075 log global
21076 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21077
21078 # log the name of the virtual server
21079 capture request header Host len 20
21080
21081 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21082 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21083
21084 # log the beginning of the referrer
21085 capture request header Referer len 20
21086
21087 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21088 capture response header Server len 20
21089
21090 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21091 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21092
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021093 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021094 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21095
21096 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21097 capture response header Via len 20
21098
21099 # log the URL location during a redirection
21100 capture response header Location len 20
21101
21102 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21103 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21104 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21105 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21106 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21107
21108 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21109 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21110 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21111 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021112 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021113
21114 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21115 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21116 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21117 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21118 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021119 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021120
21121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211228.9. Examples of logs
21123---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021124
21125These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21126them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21127reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21128
21129 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21130 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21131 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21132
21133 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21134 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21135
21136 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21137 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21138 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21139
21140 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21141 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21142
21143 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21144 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21145 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21146
21147 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021148 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021149 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21150 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21151
21152 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21153 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21154 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21155
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021156 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21157 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21158 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21159 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21160 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21161 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021162
21163 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021164 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021165
21166 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21167 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21168 Nothing was sent to any server.
21169
21170 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21171 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21172
21173 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21174 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021175 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021176 send a 408 return code to the client.
21177
21178 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21179 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21180
21181 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21182 5 seconds ("c----").
21183
21184 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21185 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021186 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021187
21188 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021189 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021190 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21191 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21192 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21193 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21194 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021195
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021196
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200211979. Supported filters
21198--------------------
21199
21200Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21201accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21202unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21203
21204See also : "filter"
21205
212069.1. Trace
21207----------
21208
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021209filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021210
21211 Arguments:
21212 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21213 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21214
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021215 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021216
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021217 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021218 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21219 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21220 amount of the parsed data.
21221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021222 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021223
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021224This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21225callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21226information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21227filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21228
21229Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21230tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21231a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21232
21233
212349.2. HTTP compression
21235---------------------
21236
21237filter compression
21238
21239The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21240keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021241when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21242fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21243done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21244explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21245filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21246listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21247order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021248
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021249See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21250 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021251
21252
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200212539.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21254--------------------------------------------
21255
21256filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21257
21258 Arguments :
21259
21260 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21261 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21262 parsed.
21263
21264 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21265 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21266 part must be placed in its own scope.
21267
21268The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21269external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021270streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021271exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21272also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21273
21274SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21275the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21276
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021277For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021278"doc/SPOE.txt".
21279
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100212809.4. Cache
21281----------
21282
21283filter cache <name>
21284
21285 Arguments :
21286
21287 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21288
21289The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21290"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021291cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021292other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21293case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21294is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21295filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021296listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21297order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021298
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021299See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21300 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21301
21302
213039.5. Fcgi-app
21304-------------
21305
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021306filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021307
21308 Arguments :
21309
21310 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21311
21312The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21313request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21314reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21315used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21316implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21317used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21318fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21319used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21320order.
21321
21322See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21323 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21324
21325
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100213269.6. OpenTracing
21327----------------
21328
21329The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21330HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21331of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21332Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21333
21334This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21335
21336The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21337HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21338participates in the work of HAProxy.
21339
21340filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21341
21342 Arguments :
21343
21344 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21345 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21346 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21347 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21348 OpenTracing filters.
21349
21350 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21351 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21352 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21353 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21354 filter must have its own scope defined.
21355
21356More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021357of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021358
21359
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002136010. FastCGI applications
21361-------------------------
21362
21363HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21364feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21365the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21366FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21367servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21368FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21369backend.
21370
21371HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21372application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21373connection.
21374
2137510.1. Setup
21376-----------
21377
2137810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21379--------------------------
21380
21381fcgi-app <name>
21382 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21383 document root must be defined.
21384
21385acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21386 Declare or complete an access list.
21387
21388 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21389 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21390 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21391 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21392 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21393
21394docroot <path>
21395 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21396 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21397 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21398
21399index <script-name>
21400 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21401 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21402 is an optional setting.
21403
21404 Example :
21405 index index.php
21406
21407log-stderr global
21408log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021409 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021410 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21411
21412 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21413 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21414
21415pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21416 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21417 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21418 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21419
21420 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21421 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21422 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21423 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21424
21425 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21426 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21427
21428path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021429 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021430 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21431 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21432 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21433 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21434 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21435 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21436 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021437
21438 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021439 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021440 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21441 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21442 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21443 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021444
21445 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021446 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21447 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021448
21449option get-values
21450no option get-values
21451 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21452
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021453 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021454 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21455
21456 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21457 application will accept.
21458
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021459 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21460 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021461
21462 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021463 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021464 option is disabled.
21465
21466 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21467 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21468 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21469 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21470 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21471 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21472
21473option keep-conn
21474no option keep-conn
21475 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21476 sending a response.
21477
21478 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21479 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21480
21481option max-reqs <reqs>
21482 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21483 accept.
21484
21485 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21486 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21487 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21488 to 1.
21489
21490option mpxs-conns
21491no option mpxs-conns
21492 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21493
21494 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21495 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21496
21497set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21498 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21499 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21500 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21501 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21502
21503 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21504 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21505 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21506
21507 Example :
21508 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21509 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21510
21511 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21512
21513
2151410.1.2. Proxy section
21515---------------------
21516
21517use-fcgi-app <name>
21518 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21519
21520 Arguments :
21521 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21522
21523 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21524 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21525 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21526 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21527 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21528
21529 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21530 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21531 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21532 application are evaluated.
21533
21534
2153510.1.3. Example
21536---------------
21537
21538 frontend front-http
21539 mode http
21540 bind *:80
21541 bind *:
21542
21543 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21544 default_backend back-static
21545
21546 backend back-static
21547 mode http
21548 server www A.B.C.D:80
21549
21550 backend back-dynamic
21551 mode http
21552 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21553 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21554
21555 fcgi-app php-fpm
21556 log-stderr global
21557 option keep-conn
21558
21559 docroot /var/www/my-app
21560 index index.php
21561 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21562
21563
2156410.2. Default parameters
21565------------------------
21566
21567A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21568the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021569script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021570applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21571
21572 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21573 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21574 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21575 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21576 | | |
21577 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21578 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21579 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21580 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21581 | | application. |
21582 | | |
21583 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21584 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21585 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21586 | | |
21587 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21588 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21589 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21590 | | the application's configuration. |
21591 | | |
21592 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21593 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21594 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21595 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21596 | | |
21597 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21598 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21599 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21600 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21601 | | be defined. |
21602 | | |
21603 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21604 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21605 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21606 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21607 | | is not set too. |
21608 | | |
21609 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21610 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21611 | | set. |
21612 | | |
21613 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21614 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21615 | | the request. |
21616 | | |
21617 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21618 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21619 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21620 | | |
21621 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21622 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21623 | | script to process the request. |
21624 | | |
21625 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21626 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21627 | | |
21628 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21629 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21630 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21631 | | |
21632 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21633 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21634 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21635 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21636 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21637 | | |
21638 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21639 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21640 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21641 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21642 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21643 | | side. |
21644 | | |
21645 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21646 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21647 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21648 | | connected to. |
21649 | | |
21650 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21651 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21652 | | |
21653 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21654 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21655 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21656 | | |
21657 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21658
21659
2166010.3. Limitations
21661------------------
21662
21663The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21664way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21665during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21666establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21667application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21668or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21669message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21670these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21671and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21672
21673Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21674request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21675requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21676
21677About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21678into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21679fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21680"http-request" ones.
21681
21682Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21683FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21684processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21685must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21686here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021687
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021688
2168911. Address formats
21690-------------------
21691
21692Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21693address.
21694
21695This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21696The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21697of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21698equivalent is '::'.
21699
21700Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21701is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21702
21703This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21704family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21705
21706Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21707configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21708use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21709'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21710
21711Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21712socket type and the transport method.
21713
21714
2171511.1 Address family prefixes
21716----------------------------
21717
21718'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21719
21720'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21721 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21722 listening.
21723
21724'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21725 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21726 on the statement using this address, a port or
21727 a port range may or must be specified.
21728
21729'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21730 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21731 using this address, a port or a port range
21732 may or must be specified.
21733
21734'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21735 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21736 using this address, a port or a port range
21737 may or must be specified.
21738
21739'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21740 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21741 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21742 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21743 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21744 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21745
21746'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21747 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21748 start by slash '/'.
21749
21750
2175111.2 Socket type prefixes
21752-------------------------
21753
21754Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21755type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21756this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21757This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21758but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21759
21760Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21761instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21762
21763If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21764they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21765report this to the maintainers.
21766
21767'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21768 to "stream"
21769
21770'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21771 to "datagram".
21772
21773
2177411.3 Protocol prefixes
21775----------------------
21776
21777'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21778 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21779 socket type and transport method is forced to
21780 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21781 this address, a port or a port range can or
21782 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21783 of 'stream+ip@'.
21784
21785'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21786 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21787 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21788 statement using this address, a port or port
21789 range can or must be specified.
21790 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21791
21792'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21793 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21794 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21795 statement using this address, a port or port
21796 range can or must be specified.
21797 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21798
21799'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21800 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21801 socket type and transport method is forced to
21802 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
21803 this address, a port or a port range can or
21804 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21805 of 'dgram+ip@'.
21806
21807'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21808 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21809 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21810 the statement using this address, a port or
21811 port range can or must be specified.
21812 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21813
21814'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21815 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21816 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21817 the statement using this address, a port or
21818 port range can or must be specified.
21819 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21820
21821'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21822 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
21823 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
21824
21825'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21826 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
21827 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
21828
21829In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
21830QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
21831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021832/*
21833 * Local variables:
21834 * fill-column: 79
21835 * End:
21836 */